blob: 25e25a2139d4f13b654f8e4480e304a77832c40c [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000042 ExprResult E = S.Owned(new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc));
43 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
44 if (E.isInvalid())
45 return ExprError();
46 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000047}
48
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000049static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
50 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000051 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
52 bool CStyle);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000053
54static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
55 QualType &ToType,
56 bool InOverloadResolution,
57 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
58 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000059static OverloadingResult
60IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
61 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
62 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
63 bool AllowExplicit);
64
65
66static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
67CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
68 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
70
71static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
72CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
73 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
75
76static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
77CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
78 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
80
81
82
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000083/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
84/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000086GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
87 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
88 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
89 ICC_Identity,
90 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
91 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
92 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000093 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000094 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
95 ICC_Promotion,
96 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000097 ICC_Promotion,
98 ICC_Conversion,
99 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Conversion,
101 ICC_Conversion,
102 ICC_Conversion,
103 ICC_Conversion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000109 ICC_Conversion
110 };
111 return Category[(int)Kind];
112}
113
114/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
115/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
116ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
117 static const ImplicitConversionRank
118 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
119 ICR_Exact_Match,
120 ICR_Exact_Match,
121 ICR_Exact_Match,
122 ICR_Exact_Match,
123 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000124 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000125 ICR_Promotion,
126 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000127 ICR_Promotion,
128 ICR_Conversion,
129 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000130 ICR_Conversion,
131 ICR_Conversion,
132 ICR_Conversion,
133 ICR_Conversion,
134 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000135 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000139 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000142 };
143 return Rank[(int)Kind];
144}
145
146/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
147/// implicit conversion.
148const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000149 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 "No conversion",
151 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
152 "Array-to-pointer",
153 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000154 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 "Qualification",
156 "Integral promotion",
157 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000158 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000159 "Integral conversion",
160 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000161 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000162 "Floating-integral conversion",
163 "Pointer conversion",
164 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000165 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000166 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000167 "Derived-to-base conversion",
168 "Vector conversion",
169 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000170 "Complex-real conversion",
171 "Block Pointer conversion",
172 "Transparent Union Conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 };
174 return Name[Kind];
175}
176
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000177/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
178/// sequence to the identity conversion.
179void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
180 First = ICK_Identity;
181 Second = ICK_Identity;
182 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000183 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000184 ReferenceBinding = false;
185 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000186 IsLvalueReference = true;
187 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
188 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000189 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000190 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000191}
192
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000193/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
194/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
195/// implicit conversions.
196ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
197 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
198 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
199 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
200 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
201 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
202 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
203 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
204 return Rank;
205}
206
207/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
208/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000209/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000211bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000212 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
213 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
214 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
215 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000216 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000217 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
218 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
219 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000220 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
222 return true;
223
224 return false;
225}
226
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000227/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
228/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
229/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
230/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000231bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000232StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000234 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000235 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000236
237 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
238 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
239 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
240 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
241 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
242
John McCall75851b12010-10-26 06:40:27 +0000243 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000244 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000245 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
246
247 return false;
248}
249
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000250/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
251/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
252void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000253 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000254 bool PrintedSomething = false;
255 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000256 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000257 PrintedSomething = true;
258 }
259
260 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
261 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000262 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000265
266 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000267 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000268 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000269 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000270 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000271 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000272 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000273 PrintedSomething = true;
274 }
275
276 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
277 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000278 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000279 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000280 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000281 PrintedSomething = true;
282 }
283
284 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000285 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000286 }
287}
288
289/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
290/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
291void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000292 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000293 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
294 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000295 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000296 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000297 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000298 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000299 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000300 After.DebugPrint();
301 }
302}
303
304/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
305/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
306void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000307 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000308 switch (ConversionKind) {
309 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000310 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000311 Standard.DebugPrint();
312 break;
313 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000314 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000315 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
316 break;
317 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000318 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000319 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000320 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000321 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000322 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000323 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000324 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000325 break;
326 }
327
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000328 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000329}
330
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000331void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
332 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
333}
334
335void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
336 conversions().~ConversionSet();
337}
338
339void
340AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
341 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
342 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
343 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
344}
345
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000346namespace {
347 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
348 // template parameter and template argument information.
349 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
350 TemplateParameter Param;
351 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
352 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
353 };
354}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000355
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000356/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
357/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
358OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000359static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
360 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000361 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000362 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
363 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
364 Result.Data = 0;
365 switch (TDK) {
366 case Sema::TDK_Success:
367 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000368 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
369 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000370 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000371
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000372 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000373 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000374 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
375 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000376
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000377 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000378 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000379 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
380 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000381 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
382 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
383 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
384 Result.Data = Saved;
385 break;
386 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000387
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000388 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000389 Result.Data = Info.take();
390 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000391
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000392 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000393 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000394 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000395 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000396
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000397 return Result;
398}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000399
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000400void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
401 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
402 case Sema::TDK_Success:
403 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
404 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000405 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
406 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000407 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000408 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000409
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000410 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000411 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000412 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000413 Data = 0;
414 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000415
416 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
417 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
418 Data = 0;
419 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000420
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000421 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000422 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000423 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
424 break;
425 }
426}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000427
428TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000429OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
430 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
431 case Sema::TDK_Success:
432 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000433 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
434 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000435 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000436 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000437
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000438 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000439 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000440 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000441
442 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000443 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000444 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000445
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000446 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000447 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000448 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
449 break;
450 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000451
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000452 return TemplateParameter();
453}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000454
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000455TemplateArgumentList *
456OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
457 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
458 case Sema::TDK_Success:
459 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
460 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
461 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
462 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
463 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
464 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000465 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000466 return 0;
467
468 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
469 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000470
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000471 // Unhandled
472 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
473 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
474 break;
475 }
476
477 return 0;
478}
479
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000480const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
481 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
482 case Sema::TDK_Success:
483 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
484 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000485 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
486 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000487 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000488 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000489 return 0;
490
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000491 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000492 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000493 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000494
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000495 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000497 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
498 break;
499 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000500
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000501 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000502}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000503
504const TemplateArgument *
505OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
506 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
507 case Sema::TDK_Success:
508 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
509 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000510 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
511 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000512 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000513 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000514 return 0;
515
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000516 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000517 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
519
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000520 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000521 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000522 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
523 break;
524 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000525
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000526 return 0;
527}
528
529void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000530 inherited::clear();
531 Functions.clear();
532}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000533
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000534// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000535// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
536// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
537// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
538// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000539// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
540// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
541// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000542//
543// Example: Given the following input:
544//
545// void f(int, float); // #1
546// void f(int, int); // #2
547// int f(int, int); // #3
548//
549// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000550// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000551//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000552// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
553// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
554// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
555// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000556//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000557// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
558// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
559// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
560// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000561// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
562// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000563//
564// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
565// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
566// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
567// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000568Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000569Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
570 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000571 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000572 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000573 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
574
575 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
577 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
578
579 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
580 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
581 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
582
583 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
584 }
585
586 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
587 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
588 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
589 // function templates hide function templates with different
590 // return types or template parameter lists.
591 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
592 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
593
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000594 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000595 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
596 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
597 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
598 continue;
599 }
600
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000601 Match = *I;
602 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000603 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000604 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000605 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
606 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
607 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
608 continue;
609 }
610
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000611 Match = *I;
612 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000613 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000614 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000615 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
616 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
617 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000618 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
619 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000620 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
621 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
622 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
623 // template instantiation.
624 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000625 // (C++ 13p1):
626 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
627 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000628 Match = *I;
629 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000630 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000631 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000632
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000633 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000634}
635
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000636bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
637 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000638 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
639 // overloads.
640 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
641 return false;
642
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000643 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
644 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
645
646 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
647 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
648 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
649 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
650 return true;
651
652 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
653 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
654 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
655
656 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
657 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
658 // in the signature, they are overloads.
659
660 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
661 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
662 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
663 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
664 return false;
665
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000666 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
667 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000668
669 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
670 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
671 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
672 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
673 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
674 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000675 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000676 return true;
677
678 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
679 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
680 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
681 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
682 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
683 // signature.
684 //
685 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
686 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000687 //
688 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
689 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
690 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000691 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
692 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
693 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
694 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
695 return true;
696
697 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000698 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000699 //
700 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
701 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
702 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
703 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
704 // can be overloaded.
705 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
706 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
707 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
708 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000709 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000710 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
711 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
712 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
713 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
714 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
715 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000716 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
717 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
718 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
719 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000720 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
721 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
722 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
723 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
724 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000725
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000726 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000727 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000728
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000729 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
730 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000731}
732
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000733/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
734/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
735/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
736/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000737///
738/// void f(float f);
739/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
740///
741/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
742/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
743/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
744/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
745//
746/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
747/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
748/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
749/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
750/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000751///
752/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
753/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000754/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
755/// permitted.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000756static ImplicitConversionSequence
757TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
758 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000759 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000760 bool InOverloadResolution,
761 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000762 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000763 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000764 ICS.Standard, CStyle)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000765 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000766 return ICS;
767 }
768
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000769 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000770 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000771 return ICS;
772 }
773
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000774 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
775 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
776 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
777 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
778 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
779 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
780 // called for those cases.
781 QualType FromType = From->getType();
782 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000783 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
784 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000785 ICS.setStandard();
786 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
787 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
788 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000789
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000790 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
791 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
792 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
793 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
794 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000795
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000796 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000797 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000798 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000799
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000800 return ICS;
801 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000802
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000803 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
804 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
805 // we can perform.
806 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000807 return ICS;
808 }
809
810 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000811 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
812 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000813 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000814 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000815
816 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000817 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000818 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
819 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
820 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
821 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
822 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
823 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
824 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000825 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000826 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000827 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000828 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
829 QualType ToCanon
830 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000831 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000832 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000833 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
834 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000835 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000836 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000837 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000838 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000839 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000840 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000841 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
842 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000843 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000844
845 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
846 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
847 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
848 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
849 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
850 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
851 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000852 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000853 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000854 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000855 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000856 ICS.setAmbiguous();
857 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
858 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
859 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
860 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
861 if (Cand->Viable)
862 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000863 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000864 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000865 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000866
867 return ICS;
868}
869
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000870bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence,
871 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
872 Expr *Initializer,
873 bool SuppressUserConversions,
874 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000875 bool InOverloadResolution,
876 bool CStyle) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000877 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
878 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(),
879 SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000880 AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000881 InOverloadResolution,
882 CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000883 if (ICS.isBad()) return true;
884
885 // Perform the actual conversion.
886 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType());
887 return false;
888}
889
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000890/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000891/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000892/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
893/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
894/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000895ExprResult
896Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000897 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
898 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
899 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
900}
901
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000902ExprResult
903Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000904 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
905 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000906 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
907 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
908 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000909 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
910 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000911 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
912}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000913
914/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000915/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000916static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000917 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
918 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
919 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000920
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000921 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
922 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
923 // - a pointer
924 // - a member pointer
925 // - a block pointer
926 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
927 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
928 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
929 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
930 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
931 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
932 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
933 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
934 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
935 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
936 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
937 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
938 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
939 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
940 } else {
941 return false;
942 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000943
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000944 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
945 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
946 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
947 return false;
948 }
949
950 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
951 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
952 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
953
954 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
955 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
956 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
957
958 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000959 return true;
960}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000961
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000962/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
963/// vector conversion.
964///
965/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
966/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000967static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
968 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000969 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
970 // conversion.
971 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
972 return false;
973
974 // Identical types require no conversions.
975 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
976 return false;
977
978 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
979 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
980 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
981 // identity conversion.
982 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
983 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000984
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000985 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000986 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000987 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
988 return true;
989 }
990 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000991
992 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
993 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
994 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
995 // same size
996 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
997 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +0000998 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
999 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001000 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1001 return true;
1002 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001003 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001004
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001005 return false;
1006}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001007
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001008/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1009/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1010/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1011/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1012/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1013/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1014/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1015/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001016static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1017 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001018 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1019 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001020 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001021
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001022 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001023 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001024 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001025 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001026 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001027 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001028
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001029 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001030 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001031 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001032 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001033 return false;
1034
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001035 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001036 }
1037
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001038 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1039 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1040 // (C++ 4p1).
1041
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001042 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001043 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1044 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001045 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001046 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001047 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1048 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1049 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001050
1051 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1052 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1053 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1054 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1055 QualType resultTy;
1056 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1057 if (!IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType,
1058 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1059 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1060 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1061 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001062 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001063
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001064 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1065 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1066 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1067 // expression.
1068 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1069 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1070 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1071 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1072 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1073 == UO_AddrOf &&
1074 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1075 const Type *ClassType
1076 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1077 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001078 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1079 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1080 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001081 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1082 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1083 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001084
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001085 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001086 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1087 FromType,
1088 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001089 } else {
1090 return false;
1091 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001093 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001094 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1095 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001096 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1097 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001098 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001099 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001100 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001101
1102 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1103 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001104 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1105 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001106 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001107 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1108 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001109 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001110
1111 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1112 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1113 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001114 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001115
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001116 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001117 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001118 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001119
1120 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1121 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1122 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1123 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001124 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1125 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001126 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001127 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001128 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001129 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001130 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001131 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001132
1133 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1134 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1135 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001136 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001137 } else {
1138 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001139 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001141 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142
1143 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1144 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1145 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1146 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001147 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1148 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001149 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001150 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001151 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1153 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001154 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001155 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001156 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001157 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001158 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001159 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001160 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001161 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001162 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001163 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001164 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001165 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1166 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001167 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1168 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1169 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1170 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1171 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1172 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1173 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1174 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1175 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001176 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001177 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001178 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001179 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001180 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001181 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001182 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001183 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1184 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001185 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1186 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001187 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1188 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1189 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001190 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001191 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1192 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1193 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001195 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001196 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001197 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001198 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001199 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001200 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001201 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1202 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001203 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1204 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001205 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001206 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001207 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001208 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001210 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001211 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001212 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001213 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1214 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001215 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1216 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001217 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001218 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001219 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001220 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001221 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1222 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001223 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1224 InOverloadResolution,
1225 SCS, CStyle)) {
1226 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1227 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001228 } else {
1229 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001230 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001231 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001232 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001233
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001234 QualType CanonFrom;
1235 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001236 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001237 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001238 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001239 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001240 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1241 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001242 } else {
1243 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001244 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1245
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001246 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001247 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1248 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1249 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001250 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1251 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001252 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001253 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001254 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1255 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001256 FromType = ToType;
1257 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1258 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001259 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001260 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001261
1262 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1263 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001264 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001265 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001266
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001267 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001268}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001269
1270static bool
1271IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1272 QualType &ToType,
1273 bool InOverloadResolution,
1274 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1275 bool CStyle) {
1276
1277 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1278 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1279 return false;
1280 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1281 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1282 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1283 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1284 itend = UD->field_end();
1285 it != itend; ++it) {
1286 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, CStyle)) {
1287 ToType = it->getType();
1288 return true;
1289 }
1290 }
1291 return false;
1292}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001293
1294/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1295/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1296/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1297/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001298bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001299 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001300 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001301 if (!To) {
1302 return false;
1303 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001304
1305 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1306 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1307 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1308 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1309 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001310 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1311 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001312 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1313 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1314 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1315 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001316 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001317 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001318 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001319 }
1320
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001321 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1322 }
1323
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001324 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1325 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1326 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1327 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1328 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1329 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001330 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001331 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001332 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001333 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1334 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001335 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001336 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1337 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1338 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1339 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1340 return false;
1341
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001342 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001343 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001344 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001345 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1346 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001347 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001348
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001349 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001350 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1351 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1352 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001353 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001354 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001355 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001356 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001357 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001358 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001359 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001360 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1361 // unsigned.
1362 bool FromIsSigned;
1363 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001364
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001365 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1366 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001367
1368 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1369 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001370 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1371 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001372 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1373 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001374 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001375 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001376 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1377 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001378 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001379 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1380 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1381 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1382 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001383 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001384 }
1385 }
1386 }
1387
1388 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1389 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1390 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1391 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1392 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1393 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1394 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001395 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1396 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001397 using llvm::APSInt;
1398 if (From)
1399 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001400 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001401 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001402 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1403 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1404 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001405
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001406 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1407 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1408 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1409 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1410 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001411
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001412 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1413 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1414 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1415 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1416 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001417
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001418 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001419 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001420 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001421
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001422 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1423 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001424 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001426 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001427
1428 return false;
1429}
1430
1431/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1432/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1433/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001434bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001435 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1436 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001437 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1438 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001439 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1440 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1441 return true;
1442
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001443 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1444 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1445 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1446 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1447 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1448 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1449 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1450 return true;
1451 }
1452
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001453 return false;
1454}
1455
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001456/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1457///
1458/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1459/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001460/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001461bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001462 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001463 if (!FromComplex)
1464 return false;
1465
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001466 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001467 if (!ToComplex)
1468 return false;
1469
1470 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001471 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1472 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1473 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001474}
1475
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001476/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1477/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1478/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1479/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1480/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001481static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001482BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001483 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1484 ASTContext &Context) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001485 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1486 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1487 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001488
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001489 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1490 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1491 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001492
1493 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001494 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001495 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001496 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001497
1498 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001499 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001500 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001501 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001502 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001503
1504 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1505 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001506 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1507 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001508 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1509 }
1510
1511 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001512 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1513 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001514
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001515 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1516 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1517 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001518}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001519
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001520static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001521 bool InOverloadResolution,
1522 ASTContext &Context) {
1523 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1524 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1525 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001526 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001527 return !InOverloadResolution;
1528
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001529 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1530 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1531 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001532}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001533
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001534/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1535/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1536/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1537/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1538/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1539/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001540///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001541/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1542/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1543/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1544/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1545/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1546/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001547/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1548/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1549/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001550bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001551 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001552 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001553 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001554 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001555 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1556 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001557 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001558
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001559 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1560 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001561 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001562 ConvertedType = ToType;
1563 return true;
1564 }
1565
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001566 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1567 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001568 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001569 ConvertedType = ToType;
1570 return true;
1571 }
1572 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1573 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001574 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001575 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001576 ConvertedType = ToType;
1577 return true;
1578 }
1579
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001580 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1581 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001582 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001583 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001584 ConvertedType = ToType;
1585 return true;
1586 }
1587
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001588 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001589 if (!ToTypePtr)
1590 return false;
1591
1592 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001593 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001594 ConvertedType = ToType;
1595 return true;
1596 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001597
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001598 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001599 // , including objective-c pointers.
1600 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1601 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001602 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1603 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1604 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001605 ToType, Context);
1606 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001607 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001608 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001609 if (!FromTypePtr)
1610 return false;
1611
1612 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001613
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001614 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001615 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1616 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1617 return false;
1618
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001619 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1620 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1621 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001622 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1623 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001624 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001625 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001626 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001627 return true;
1628 }
1629
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001630 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1631 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001632 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001633 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001634 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001635 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001636 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001637 return true;
1638 }
1639
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001640 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001641 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001642 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1643 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1644 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1645 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1646 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1647 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1648 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1649 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1650 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001651 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1652 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001653 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1654 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001655 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001656 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001657 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001658 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001659 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001660 ToType, Context);
1661 return true;
1662 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001663
Fariborz Jahanianbc2ee932011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001664 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1665 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1666 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1667 ToPointeeType,
1668 ToType, Context);
1669 return true;
1670 }
1671
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001672 return false;
1673}
1674
1675/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1676/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1677/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001678bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001679 QualType& ConvertedType,
1680 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1681 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1682 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001683
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001684 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001685 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1686 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001687 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001688 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001689
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001690 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001691 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1692 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1693 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1694 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1695 return false;
1696
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001697 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001698 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001699 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001700 ConvertedType = ToType;
1701 return true;
1702 }
1703 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001704 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001705 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001706 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001707 /*compare=*/false)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001708 ConvertedType = ToType;
1709 return true;
1710 }
1711 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1712 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1713 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001714 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1715 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1716 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1717 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1718 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1719 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001720 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001721 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1722 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001723 return true;
1724 }
1725
1726 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1727 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1728 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1729 // complain about it.
1730 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001731 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001732 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1733 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001734 return true;
1735 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001736 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001737 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001738 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001739 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001740 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001741 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001742 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001743 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001744 // to a block pointer type.
1745 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1746 ConvertedType = ToType;
1747 return true;
1748 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001749 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001750 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001751 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001752 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001753 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001754 // pointer to any object.
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001755 ConvertedType = ToType;
1756 return true;
1757 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001758 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001759 return false;
1760
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001761 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001762 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001763 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001764 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1765 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001766 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1767 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001768 return false;
1769
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001770 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1771 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1772 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1773 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1774 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1775 // We always complain about this conversion.
1776 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001777 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001778 return true;
1779 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001780 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1781 // as in I* to id.
1782 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1783 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1784 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1785 IncompatibleObjC)) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001786 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001787 return true;
1788 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001789
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001790 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001791 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1792 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1793 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001794 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001795 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001796 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001797 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001798 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1799 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1800 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1801 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1802 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1803 return false;
1804
1805 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1806 // function types are obviously different.
1807 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1808 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1809 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1810 return false;
1811
1812 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1813 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1814 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1815 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1816 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1817 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1818 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1819 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1820 HasObjCConversion = true;
1821 } else {
1822 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1823 return false;
1824 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001825
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001826 // Check argument types.
1827 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1828 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1829 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1830 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1831 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1832 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1833 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1834 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1835 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1836 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1837 HasObjCConversion = true;
1838 } else {
1839 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1840 return false;
1841 }
1842 }
1843
1844 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1845 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1846 // conversion, but complain about it.
1847 ConvertedType = ToType;
1848 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1849 return true;
1850 }
1851 }
1852
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001853 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001854}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001855
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001856bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1857 QualType& ConvertedType) {
1858 QualType ToPointeeType;
1859 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1860 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1861 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1862 else
1863 return false;
1864
1865 QualType FromPointeeType;
1866 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1867 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1868 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1869 else
1870 return false;
1871 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
1872 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1873 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
1874
1875 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
1876 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1877 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
1878 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1879
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001880 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
1881 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001882
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001883 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001884 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001885
1886 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1887 // function types are obviously different.
1888 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1889 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
1890 return false;
1891
1892 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1893 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1894 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
1895 return false;
1896
1897 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00001898 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1899 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001900 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1901 } else {
1902 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
1903 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
1904 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
1905 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
1906 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
1907
1908 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
1909 // OK exact match.
1910 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
1911 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1912 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1913 return false;
1914 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1915 }
1916 else
1917 return false;
1918 }
1919
1920 // Check argument types.
1921 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1922 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1923 IncompatibleObjC = false;
1924 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1925 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1926 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
1927 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1928 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
1929 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1930 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1931 return false;
1932 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1933 } else
1934 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1935 return false;
1936 }
1937 ConvertedType = ToType;
1938 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001939}
1940
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001941/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1942/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1943/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1944/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001945bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001946 const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001947 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1948 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1949 NewType->arg_type_begin());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001950
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001951 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1952 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1953 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1954 QualType ToType = (*O);
1955 QualType FromType = (*N);
1956 if (ToType != FromType) {
1957 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1958 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001959 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1960 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1961 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1962 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001963 continue;
1964 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001965 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1966 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001967 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001968 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1969 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1970 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001971 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001972 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001973 }
1974 }
1975 return true;
1976}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001977
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001978/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
1979/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00001980/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001981/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
1982/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
1983/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001984bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001985 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001986 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001987 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001988 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001989 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001990
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001991 Kind = CK_BitCast;
1992
Chandler Carruthffab8732011-04-09 07:32:05 +00001993 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
1994 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
1995 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
1996 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruth66a7b042011-04-09 07:48:17 +00001997 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
1998 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001999
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002000 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2001 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002002 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2003 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002004
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002005 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2006 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002007 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2008 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002009 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2010 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002011 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002012 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002013 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002014
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002015 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002016 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002017 }
2018 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002019 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002020 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002021 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002022 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002023 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2024 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2025 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002026 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002027 return false;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002028 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002029 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002030
2031 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2032 // reasons.
2033 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2034 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2035
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002036 return false;
2037}
2038
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002039/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2040/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2041/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2042/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2043/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2044bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002045 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002046 bool InOverloadResolution,
2047 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002048 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002049 if (!ToTypePtr)
2050 return false;
2051
2052 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002053 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2054 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2055 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002056 ConvertedType = ToType;
2057 return true;
2058 }
2059
2060 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002061 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002062 if (!FromTypePtr)
2063 return false;
2064
2065 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2066 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2067 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2068 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002069
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002070 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2071 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2072 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002073 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2074 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2075 return true;
2076 }
2077
2078 return false;
2079}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002080
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002081/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2082/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002083/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002084/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2085/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2086/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002088 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002089 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002090 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002091 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002092 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002093 if (!FromPtrType) {
2094 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002095 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002096 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002097 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002098 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002099 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002100 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002101
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002102 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002103 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2104 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002105
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002106 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2107 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002108
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002109 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2110 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2111 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002112
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002113 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002114 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002115 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2116 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2117 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2118 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002119
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002120 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2121 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002122 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2123 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2124 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2125 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002126 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002127
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002128 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002129 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2130 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2131 << From->getSourceRange();
2132 return true;
2133 }
2134
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002135 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002136 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2137 Paths.front(),
2138 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002139
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002140 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002141 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002142 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002143 return false;
2144}
2145
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002146/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2147/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2148/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002150Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002151 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002152 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2153 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2154
2155 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2156 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002157 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002158 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002159
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002160 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2161 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2162 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2163 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002164 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002165 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002166 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2167 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2168 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002169 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002170 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2171 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002172 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002173
2174 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2175 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002176 if (!CStyle && !ToType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromType))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002177 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002179 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2180 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002181 if (!CStyle && FromType.getCVRQualifiers() != ToType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002182 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002183 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002184
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002185 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2186 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002188 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToType.isConstQualified();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002189 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002190
2191 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2192 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2193 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2194 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2195 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002196 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002197}
2198
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002199/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2200/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2201/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2202/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2203/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2204/// false and User is unspecified.
2205///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002206/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2207/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2208/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002209static OverloadingResult
2210IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2211 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2212 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2213 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002214 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2215 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2216
2217 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2218 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002219 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002220 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2221 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2222 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2223 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2224 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2225 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2226 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2227 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002228 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002229 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002230 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002231 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2232
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002233 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag())) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002234 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2235 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2236 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002237 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002238 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002239 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002240 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2241 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2242
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002243 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2244 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2245 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002246 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002247 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002248 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002249 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2250 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002251 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002252
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002253 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002254 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002255 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002256 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2257 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002258 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002259 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2260 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002261 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002262 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2263 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002264 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2265 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2266 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2267 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002268 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002269 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002270 }
2271 }
2272
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002273 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2274 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002275 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2276 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002277 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002278 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002279 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002280 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002281 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2282 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002283 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002284 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002285 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002286 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002287 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2288 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002289 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2290 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2291 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2292
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002293 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2294 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002295 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2296 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002297 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002298 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002299
2300 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2301 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002302 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2303 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2304 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002305 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002306 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2307 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002308 }
2309 }
2310 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002311 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002312
2313 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002314 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002315 case OR_Success:
2316 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2317 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2318 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002319 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2320
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002321 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2322 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2323 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2324 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2325 // the argument of the constructor.
2326 //
2327 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2328 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2329 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2330 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002331 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002332 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002333 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002334 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002335 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002336 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2337 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2338 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2339 return OR_Success;
2340 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2341 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002342 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2343
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002344 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2345 //
2346 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2347 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2348 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2349 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2350 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2351 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002352 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002353 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002354
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002355 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2356 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2357 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2358 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2359 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2360 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2361 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2362 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2363 // 13.3.3.1).
2364 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2365 return OR_Success;
2366 } else {
2367 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002368 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002369 }
2370
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002371 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2372 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2373 case OR_Deleted:
2374 // No conversion here! We're done.
2375 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002376
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002377 case OR_Ambiguous:
2378 return OR_Ambiguous;
2379 }
2380
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002381 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002382}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002383
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002384bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002385Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002386 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002387 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002388 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002389 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002390 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002391 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2392 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2393 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2394 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2395 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2396 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2397 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2398 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2399 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002400 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002401 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002402 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002403}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002404
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002405/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2406/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2407/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002408static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2409CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2410 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2411 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002412{
2413 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2414 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2415 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2416 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2417 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2418 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2419 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2420 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002421 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002422 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2423 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2424 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2425 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2426 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002427 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2428 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2429 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2430 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002431
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002432 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2433 // the same kind.
2434 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2435 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2436
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002437 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2438 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2439 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002440 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002441 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002442 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002443 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2444 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2445 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2446 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2447 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2448 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002449 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002450 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002451 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2452 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002453 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2454 }
2455
2456 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2457}
2458
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002459static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2460 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2461 Qualifiers Quals;
2462 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002463 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002464 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002465
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002466 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2467}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002468
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002469// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2470// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2471static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2472compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2473 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2474 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2475 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2476 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2477
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002478 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002479 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2480 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2481 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2482 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2483 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2484 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2485 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002486
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002487 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2488 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2489 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2490 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2491 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2492 else
2493 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002494 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002495 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2496
2497 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2498 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2499 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2500 }
2501
2502 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2503 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2504 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2505 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2506
2507 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2508 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2509 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2510 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002511
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002512 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2513}
2514
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002515/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2516/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2517static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2518 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2519 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2520 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2521 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002522 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002523 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002524 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002525 // reference*.
2526 //
2527 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2528 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2529 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2530 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2531 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00002532 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2533 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2534 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002535
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002536 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2537 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2538 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2539 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2540}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002541
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002542/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2543/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2544/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002545static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2546CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2547 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2548 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002549{
2550 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2551 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2552
2553 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2554 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2555 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2556 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2557 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002558 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002559 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002560 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002561
2562 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2563 // defined below), or, if not that,
2564 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2565 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2566 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2567 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2568 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2569 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002570
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002571 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2572 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2573 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002574
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002575 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2576 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2577 // that is such a conversion.
2578 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2579 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2580 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2581 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2582
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002583 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2584 //
2585 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002586 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2587 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2588 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002589 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002590 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002591 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002592 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002593 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2594 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2595 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002596 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2597 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002598 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2599 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2600 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002601 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002602 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002603 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002604 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2605 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2606 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2607 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002608 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2609 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002610
2611 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2612 // conversion, if we need to.
2613 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002614 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002615 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002616 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002617
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002618 QualType FromPointee1
2619 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2620 QualType FromPointee2
2621 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002622
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002623 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002624 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002625 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002626 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2627
2628 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2629 // other, it is the better one.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002630 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2631 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002632 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002633 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002634 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002635 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002636 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2637 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002638 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002639
2640 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2641 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002642 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002643 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002644 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002645
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002646 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002647 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2648 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2649 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2650 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002652
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002653 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2654 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2655 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2656 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2657 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2658 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002659 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2660 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002661 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2662 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002663 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002664 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2665 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002666 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002667 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2668 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002669 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002670 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002671 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002672 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002673 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2674 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2675 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2676 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2677 }
2678 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002679
2680 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2681}
2682
2683/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2684/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002685/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2686ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002687CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2688 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2689 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002690 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002691 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2692 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2693 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2694 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2695 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2696 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2697 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2698 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2699
2700 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2701 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002702 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2703 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002704 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2705 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002706 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002707 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2708 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002709
2710 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2711 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002712 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002713 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2714
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002715 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2716 // for comparison.
2717 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002718 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002719 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002720 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002721
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002722 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002723 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002724 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002725 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2726 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2727 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002728 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002729 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2730 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2731 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2732 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2733 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2734 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2735 // about how the sequences rank.
2736 ;
2737 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2738 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2739 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2740 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2741 // qualifiers.
2742 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002743
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002744 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2745 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2746 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2747 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2748 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2749 // qualifiers.
2750 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002751
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002752 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2753 } else {
2754 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2755 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2756 }
2757
2758 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002759 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002760 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002761 }
2762
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002763 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2764 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2765 switch (Result) {
2766 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002767 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002768 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2769 break;
2770
2771 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2772 break;
2773
2774 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002775 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002776 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2777 break;
2778 }
2779
2780 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002781}
2782
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002783/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2784/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002785/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2786/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2787/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002788ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002789CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2790 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2791 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002792 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002793 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002794 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002795 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002796
2797 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2798 // conversion, if we need to.
2799 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002800 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002801 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002802 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002803
2804 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002805 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2806 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2807 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2808 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002809
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002810 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002811 //
2812 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2813 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002814 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002815 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002816 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002817 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2818 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2819 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2820 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002821 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002822 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002823 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002824 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002825 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002826 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002827 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002828 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002829
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002830 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002831 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002832 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002833 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002834 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002835 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2836 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002837
2838 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2839 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002840 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002841 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002842 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002843 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002844 }
2845 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2846 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
2847 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
2848 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2849 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
2850 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2851 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
2852 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2853 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
2854 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2855
2856 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
2857 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
2858 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
2859 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
2860 // Objective-C pointer types.
2861 bool FromAssignLeft
2862 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
2863 bool FromAssignRight
2864 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
2865 bool ToAssignLeft
2866 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
2867 bool ToAssignRight
2868 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
2869
2870 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
2871 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
2872 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
2873 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2874 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2875 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
2876 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2877 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2878
2879 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
2880 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
2881 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2882 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2883 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2884 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2885
2886 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
2887 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
2888 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2889 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2890 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2891 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
2892 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2893 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2894
2895 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
2896 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
2897 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2898 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2899 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2900 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002901
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002902 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2903 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2904 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2905 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
2906 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2907 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2908
2909 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2910 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
2911 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
2912 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2913 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002914 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002915 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002916
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002917 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002918 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2919 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2920 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002921 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002922 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002923 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002924 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002925 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002926 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002927 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002928 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2929 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2930 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2931 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2932 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2933 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2934 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2935 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2936 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002937 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002938 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002939 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002940 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002941 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002942 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2943 }
2944 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2945 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002946 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002947 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002948 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002949 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2950 }
2951 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002952
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002953 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002954 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002955 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2956 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2957 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002958 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2959 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2960 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002961 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002962 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002963 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2964 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002965
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002966 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002967 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
2968 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2969 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002970 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2971 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2972 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002973 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002974 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002975 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2976 }
2977 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002978
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002979 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2980}
2981
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002982/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
2983/// determine whether they are reference-related,
2984/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
2985/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
2986/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
2987/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
2988/// type being initialized.
2989Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
2990Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
2991 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002992 bool &DerivedToBase,
2993 bool &ObjCConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002994 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
2995 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
2996 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
2997
2998 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
2999 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3000 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3001 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3002 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3003
3004 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3005 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3006 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3007 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003008 DerivedToBase = false;
3009 ObjCConversion = false;
3010 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3011 // Nothing to do.
3012 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003013 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3014 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003015 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3016 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3017 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3018 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003019 else
3020 return Ref_Incompatible;
3021
3022 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3023 // least).
3024
3025 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3026 // for comparison.
3027 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3028 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3029 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3030 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3031
3032 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3033 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3034 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3035 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3036 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3037 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3038 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
3039 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
3040 return Ref_Compatible;
3041 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3042 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3043 else
3044 return Ref_Related;
3045}
3046
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003047/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003048/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3049static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003050FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3051 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3052 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3053 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003054 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3055 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3056 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3057
3058 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3059 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3060 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3061 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3062 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3063 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3064 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3065 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3066 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3067
3068 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3069 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3070 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3071 if (ConvTemplate)
3072 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3073 else
3074 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3075
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003076 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003077 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3078 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3079 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003080
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003081 if (AllowRvalues) {
3082 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3083 bool ObjCConversion = false;
3084 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003085 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3086 DeclLoc,
3087 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3088 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3089 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
3090 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) ==
3091 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003092 continue;
3093 } else {
3094 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3095 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3096 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3097
3098 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3099 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3100 if (!RefType ||
3101 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3102 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3103 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003104 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003105
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003106 if (ConvTemplate)
3107 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003108 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003109 else
3110 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003111 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003112 }
3113
3114 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003115 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003116 case OR_Success:
3117 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3118 //
3119 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3120 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3121 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3122 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3123 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3124 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3125 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3126 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3127 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3128 return false;
3129
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003130 if (Best->Function)
3131 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003132 ICS.setUserDefined();
3133 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3134 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3135 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00003136 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003137 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3138 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3139 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3140 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3141 return true;
3142
3143 case OR_Ambiguous:
3144 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3145 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3146 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3147 if (Cand->Viable)
3148 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3149 return true;
3150
3151 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3152 case OR_Deleted:
3153 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3154 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3155 return false;
3156 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003157
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00003158 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003159}
3160
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003161/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3162/// initialization.
3163static ImplicitConversionSequence
3164TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3165 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3166 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003167 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003168 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3169
3170 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3171 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3172 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3173
3174 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3175 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3176
3177 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3178 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3179 // type of the resulting function.
3180 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3181 DeclAccessPair Found;
3182 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3183 false, Found))
3184 T2 = Fn->getType();
3185 }
3186
3187 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3188 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3189 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003190 bool ObjCConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003191 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003192 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003193 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
3194 ObjCConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003195
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003196
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003197 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003198 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3199 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3200
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003201 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003202 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003203 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3204 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3205 //
3206 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3207 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3208 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003209 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003210 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3211 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3212 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3213 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3214 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3215 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3216 ICS.setStandard();
3217 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003218 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3219 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3220 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003221 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3222 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3223 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3224 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3225 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3226 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3227 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003228 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3229 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3230 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003231 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003232 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003233
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003234 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3235 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3236 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3237 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003238 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003239 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003240
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003241 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3242 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3243 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3244 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3245 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3246 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3247 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3248 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003249 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003250 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003251 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3252 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3253 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003254 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003255 }
3256 }
3257
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003258 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3259 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003260 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003261 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003262 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3263 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3264 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3265 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3266 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3267 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3268 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003269 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3270 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003271 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003272 return ICS;
3273
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003274 // -- If the initializer expression
3275 //
3276 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
3277 // lvalue and "cv1T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
3278 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3279 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3280 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3281 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3282 ICS.setStandard();
3283 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003284 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003285 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3286 : ICK_Identity;
3287 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3288 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3289 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3290 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3291 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3292 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3293 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3294 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3295 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3296 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3297 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003298 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3299 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003300 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003301 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3302 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003303 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003304 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003305 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003306 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003307 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003308
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003309 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3310 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003311 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3312 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003313 // "cv3 T3",
3314 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003315 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003316 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003317 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003318 // class subobject).
3319 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003320 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003321 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3322 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3323 AllowExplicit)) {
3324 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3325 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3326 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3327 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003328 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003329 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3330 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3331
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00003332 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00003333 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003334
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003335 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3336 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3337 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3338 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3339 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3340 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3341 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3342 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3343 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3344 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3345 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3346 // initialization fails.
3347 return ICS;
3348 }
3349
3350 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3351 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3352 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3353 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3354 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3355 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3356 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3357 return ICS;
3358
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003359 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3360 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3361 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3362 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3363 return ICS;
3364
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003365 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003366 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3367 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3368 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3369 // underlying type of the reference according to
3370 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3371 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3372 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3373 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3374 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003375 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3376 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003377 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3378 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003379
3380 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3381 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3382 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003383 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3384 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3385 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003386 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003387 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3388 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003389 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3390 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3391 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003392 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003393 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003394
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003395 return ICS;
3396}
3397
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003398/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3399/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3400/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3401/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003402/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003403/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003404static ImplicitConversionSequence
3405TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003406 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003407 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003408 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003409 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003410 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3411 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003412 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003413
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003414 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3415 SuppressUserConversions,
3416 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003417 InOverloadResolution,
3418 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003419}
3420
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003421/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3422/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3423/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003424static ImplicitConversionSequence
3425TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003426 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003427 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3428 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3429 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003430 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3431 // const volatile object.
3432 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3433 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003434 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003435
3436 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3437 // to exit early.
3438 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003439
3440 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003441 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003442 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003443 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3444
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003445 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3446 // better have an lvalue.
3447 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3448 }
3449
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003450 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003451
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003452 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003453 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003454 // parameter is
3455 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003456 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3457 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3458 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003459 // ref-qualifier
3460 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003461 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003462 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3463 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003464 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003465 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003466 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3467 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3468 // non-constant references.
3469
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003470 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003471 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003472 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003473 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003474 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003475 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3476 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003477 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003478 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003479
3480 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3481 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003482 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003483 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3484 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3485 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003486 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003487 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003488 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003489 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3490 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003491 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003492 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003493
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003494 // Check the ref-qualifier.
3495 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3496 case RQ_None:
3497 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3498 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003499
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003500 case RQ_LValue:
3501 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3502 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003503 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003504 ImplicitParamType);
3505 return ICS;
3506 }
3507 break;
3508
3509 case RQ_RValue:
3510 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3511 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003512 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003513 ImplicitParamType);
3514 return ICS;
3515 }
3516 break;
3517 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003518
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003519 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003520 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003521 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3522 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003523 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003524 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003525 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3526 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003527 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003528 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003529 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
3530 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
3531 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003532 return ICS;
3533}
3534
3535/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3536/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3537/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003538ExprResult
3539Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003540 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003541 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003542 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003543 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003544 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003545 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003546
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003547 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003548 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003549 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3550 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003551 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003552 } else {
3553 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3554 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003555 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003556 }
3557
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003558 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3559 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003560 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003561 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
3562 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003563 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3564 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3565 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3566 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3567 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3568 if (CVR) {
3569 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3570 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3571 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3572 << From->getSourceRange();
3573 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3574 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003575 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003576 }
3577 }
3578
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003579 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003580 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003581 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003582 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003583
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003584 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3585 ExprResult FromRes =
3586 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
3587 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
3588 return ExprError();
3589 From = FromRes.take();
3590 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003591
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003592 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003593 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
3594 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
3595 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003596}
3597
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003598/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3599/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003600static ImplicitConversionSequence
3601TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003602 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003603 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003604 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3605 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003606 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003607 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3608 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003609}
3610
3611/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3612/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003613ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003614 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003615 if (!ICS.isBad())
3616 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003617
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003618 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003619 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3620 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
3621 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003622 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003623}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003624
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003625/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3626/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003627static ImplicitConversionSequence
3628TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3629 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3630 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3631 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3632 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3633 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003634 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3635 /*CStyle=*/false);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003636}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003637
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003638/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3639/// of the expression From to 'id'.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003640ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003641 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003642 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003643 if (!ICS.isBad())
3644 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003645 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003646}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003647
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003648/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003649/// enumeration type.
3650///
3651/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3652/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3653/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3654///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003655/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3656/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003657///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003658/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3659///
3660/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3661/// have integral or enumeration type.
3662///
3663/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3664/// incomplete class type.
3665///
3666/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3667/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3668/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3669///
3670/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3671/// showing which conversion was picked.
3672///
3673/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3674/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3675///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003676/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003677/// usable conversion function.
3678///
3679/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3680/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3681///
3682/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3683/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003684ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003685Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003686 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3687 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3688 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3689 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3690 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003691 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3692 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003693 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3694 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003695 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003696
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003697 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3698 QualType T = From->getType();
3699 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003700 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003701
3702 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3703
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003704 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003705 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3706 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3707 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3708 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3709 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003710 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003711 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003712
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003713 // We must have a complete class type.
3714 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003715 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003716
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003717 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3718 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3719 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3720 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3721 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003722
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003723 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003724 E = Conversions->end();
3725 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003726 ++I) {
3727 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3728 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3729 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3730 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3731 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3732 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3733 else
3734 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3735 }
3736 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003737
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003738 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3739 case 0:
3740 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3741 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3742 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3743 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003744
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003745 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3746 // conversion; use it.
3747 QualType ConvTy
3748 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3749 std::string TypeStr;
3750 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003751
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003752 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3753 << T << ConvTy
3754 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3755 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3756 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3757 ")");
3758 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3759 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003760
3761 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003762 // explicit conversion function.
3763 if (isSFINAEContext())
3764 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003765
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003766 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003767 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
3768 if (Result.isInvalid())
3769 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003770
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003771 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003772 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003773
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003774 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3775 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003776
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003777 case 1: {
3778 // Apply this conversion.
3779 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3780 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003781
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003782 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3783 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3784 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003785 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003786 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3787 if (isSFINAEContext())
3788 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003789
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003790 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3791 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3792 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003793
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003794 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003795 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003796 if (Result.isInvalid())
3797 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003798
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003799 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003800 break;
3801 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003802
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003803 default:
3804 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3805 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3806 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3807 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3808 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3809 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3810 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3811 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3812 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003813 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003814 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003815
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003816 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003817 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3818 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003819
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003820 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003821}
3822
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003823/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003824/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3825/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3826/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003827///
3828/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3829/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3830/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003831void
3832Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003833 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003834 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003835 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003836 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003837 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003838 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003839 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003840 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003841 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003842 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003843
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003844 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003845 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3846 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3847 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3848 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3849 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003850 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3851 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3852 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003853 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003854 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003855 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003856 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003857 return;
3858 }
3859 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3860 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003861 }
3862
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003863 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003864 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003865
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003866 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003867 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003868
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003869 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3870 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3871 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3872 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3873 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003874 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00003875 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003876 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3877 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003878 return;
3879 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003880
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003881 // Add this candidate
3882 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3883 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003884 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003885 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003886 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003887 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003888 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00003889 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003890
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003891 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3892
3893 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3894 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3895 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003896 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003897 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003898 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003899 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003900 return;
3901 }
3902
3903 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3904 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3905 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3906 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3907 // exactly m parameters.
3908 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003909 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003910 // Not enough arguments.
3911 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003912 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003913 return;
3914 }
3915
3916 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3917 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003918 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3919 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3920 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3921 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3922 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3923 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3924 // parameter of F.
3925 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003926 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003927 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003928 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003929 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003930 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3931 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003932 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003933 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003934 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003935 } else {
3936 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3937 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3938 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003939 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003940 }
3941 }
3942}
3943
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003944/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3945/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003946void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003947 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3948 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3949 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003950 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003951 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3952 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003953 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003954 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003955 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003956 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003957 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003958 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3959 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003960 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003961 SuppressUserConversions);
3962 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003963 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003964 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3965 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003966 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003967 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003968 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003969 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003970 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
3971 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003972 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003973 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003974 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003975 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003976 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003977 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
3978 SuppressUserConversions);
3979 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003980 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003981}
3982
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003983/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
3984/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003985void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003986 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003987 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003988 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3989 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003990 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003991 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003992 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003993
3994 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
3995 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003996
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003997 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
3998 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3999 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004000 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4001 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004002 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004003 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004004 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004005 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004006 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004007 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004008 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004009 }
4010}
4011
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004012/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4013/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4014/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4015/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4016/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4017/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004018/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004019void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004020Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004021 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004022 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004023 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004024 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004025 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004026 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004027 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004028 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004029 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4030 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004031
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004032 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4033 return;
4034
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004035 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004036 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004037
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004038 // Add this candidate
4039 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4040 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004041 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004042 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004043 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004044 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004045 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004046
4047 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4048
4049 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4050 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4051 // list (8.3.5).
4052 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4053 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004054 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004055 return;
4056 }
4057
4058 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4059 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4060 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4061 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4062 // exactly m parameters.
4063 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4064 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4065 // Not enough arguments.
4066 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004067 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004068 return;
4069 }
4070
4071 Candidate.Viable = true;
4072 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4073
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004074 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004075 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4076 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4077 else {
4078 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4079 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004080 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004081 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4082 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004083 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004084 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004085 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004086 return;
4087 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004088 }
4089
4090 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4091 // arguments.
4092 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4093 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4094 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4095 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4096 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4097 // parameter of F.
4098 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004100 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004101 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00004102 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004103 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004104 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004105 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004106 break;
4107 }
4108 } else {
4109 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4110 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4111 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004112 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004113 }
4114 }
4115}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004116
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004117/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4118/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4119/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004120void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004121Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004122 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004123 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004124 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004125 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004126 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004127 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004128 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004129 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004130 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4131 return;
4132
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004133 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004134 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004135 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004136 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004137 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4138 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4139 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4140 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4141 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004142 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004143 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4144 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004145 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004146 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004147 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4148 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4149 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4150 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4151 Candidate.Viable = false;
4152 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4153 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4154 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004155 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004156 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004157 Info);
4158 return;
4159 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004160
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004161 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4162 // deduction as a candidate.
4163 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004164 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004165 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004166 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004167 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4168 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004169}
4170
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004171/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4172/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4173/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004174void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004175Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004176 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004177 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004178 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4179 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004180 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004181 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4182 return;
4183
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004184 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004185 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004186 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004187 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004188 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4189 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4190 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4191 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4192 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004193 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004194 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4195 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004196 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004197 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004198 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4199 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004200 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004201 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4202 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004203 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004204 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4205 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004206 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004207 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004208 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004209 return;
4210 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004211
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004212 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4213 // deduction as a candidate.
4214 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004215 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004216 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004217}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004218
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004219/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004220/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004221/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004222/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004223/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4224/// conversion function produces).
4225void
4226Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004227 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004228 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004229 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4230 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004231 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4232 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004233 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004234 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4235 return;
4236
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004237 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004238 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004239
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004240 // Add this candidate
4241 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4242 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004243 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004244 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004245 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004246 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004247 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004248 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004249 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004250 Candidate.Viable = true;
4251 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004252 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004253
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004254 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004255 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4256 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004257 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004258 //
4259 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4260 // object parameter.
4261 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4262 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4263 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4264 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4265 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004266
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004267 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004268 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4269 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004270 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004271
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004272 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004273 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004274 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004275 return;
4276 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004277
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004278 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004279 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4280 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4281 QualType FromCanon
4282 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4283 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4284 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4285 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004286 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004287 return;
4288 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004289
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004290 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4291 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4292 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4293 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4294 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4295 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4296 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4297 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004298 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004299 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004300 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4301 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004302 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00004303 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004304
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00004305 QualType CallResultType
4306 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
4307 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) {
4308 Candidate.Viable = false;
4309 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4310 return;
4311 }
4312
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004313 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType());
4314
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004315 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004316 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4317 // allocator).
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004318 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00004319 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004320 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004321 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004322 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004323 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004324
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004325 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004326 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4327 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004328
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004329 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4330 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004331 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004332 // shall have exact match rank.
4333 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4334 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4335 Candidate.Viable = false;
4336 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4337 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004338
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004339 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4340 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4341 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4342 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4343 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004344 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004345 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4346 Candidate.Viable = false;
4347 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4348 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004349 break;
4350
4351 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4352 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004353 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004354 break;
4355
4356 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004357 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004358 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4359 }
4360}
4361
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004362/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4363/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4364/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4365/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4366/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004367void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004368Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004369 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004370 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004371 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4372 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4373 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4374 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4375
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004376 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4377 return;
4378
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004379 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004380 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4381 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004382 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004383 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004384 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4385 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4386 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4387 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4388 Candidate.Viable = false;
4389 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4390 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4391 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004392 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004393 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004394 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004395 return;
4396 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004397
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004398 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4399 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4400 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004401 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004402 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004403}
4404
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004405/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4406/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4407/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4408/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4409/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4410void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004411 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004412 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004413 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004414 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004415 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004416 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004417 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4418 return;
4419
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004420 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004421 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004422
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004423 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4424 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004425 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004426 Candidate.Function = 0;
4427 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4428 Candidate.Viable = true;
4429 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004430 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004431 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004432 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004433
4434 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4435 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004436 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004437 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004438 Object->Classify(Context),
4439 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004440 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004441 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004442 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004443 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004444 return;
4445 }
4446
4447 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4448 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4449 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004450 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004451 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004452 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004453 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004454 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00004455 = FoundDecl.getDecl();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004456 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004457 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4458 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4459
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004460 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004461 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4462
4463 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4464 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4465 // list (8.3.5).
4466 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4467 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004468 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004469 return;
4470 }
4471
4472 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4473 // we have enough arguments.
4474 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4475 // Not enough arguments.
4476 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004477 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004478 return;
4479 }
4480
4481 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4482 // arguments.
4483 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4484 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4485 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4486 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4487 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4488 // parameter of F.
4489 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004490 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004491 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004492 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004493 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004494 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004495 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004496 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004497 break;
4498 }
4499 } else {
4500 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4501 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4502 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004503 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004504 }
4505 }
4506}
4507
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004508/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4509/// member functions.
4510///
4511/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4512/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4513/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4514/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4515/// [over.match.oper]).
4516void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4517 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4518 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4519 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4520 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004521 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4522
4523 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4524 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4525 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4526 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4527 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4528 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4529 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4530 // constructed as follows:
4531 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004532
4533 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4534 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4535 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4536 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004537 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004538 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004539 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004540 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004541
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004542 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4543 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4544 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4545
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004546 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004547 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4548 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004549 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004550 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004551 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004552 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004553 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004554 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004555}
4556
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004557/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4558/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4559/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004560/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4561/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004562/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4563/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4564/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004565void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004566 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004567 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004568 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4569 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004570 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004571 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004572
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004573 // Add this candidate
4574 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4575 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004576 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004577 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004578 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004579 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004580 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4581 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4582 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4583
4584 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4585 // arguments.
4586 Candidate.Viable = true;
4587 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004588 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004589 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004590 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4591 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4592 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4593 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4594 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4595 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004596 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004597 //
4598 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4599 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4600 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4601 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004602 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004603 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004604 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004605 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4606 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004607 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004608 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004609 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004610 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004611 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004612 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004613 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004614 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004615 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004616 break;
4617 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004618 }
4619}
4620
4621/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4622/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4623/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4624/// enumeration types.
4625class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4626 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004627 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004628
4629 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4630 /// built-in candidates.
4631 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4632
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004633 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4634 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4635 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4636
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004637 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4638 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4639 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4640
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004641 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004642 /// candidates.
4643 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004644
4645 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4646 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4647
4648 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4649 /// were present in the candidate set.
4650 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4651
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004652 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4653 /// candidate type set.
4654 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004655
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004656 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4657 ASTContext &Context;
4658
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004659 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4660 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004661 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004662
4663public:
4664 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004665 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004666
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004667 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004668 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4669 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
4670 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4671 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004672
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004673 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004674 SourceLocation Loc,
4675 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004676 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4677 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004678
4679 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4680 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4681
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004682 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004683 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4684
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004685 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4686 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4687
4688 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4689 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4690
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004691 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4692 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4693
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004694 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004695 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004696
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004697 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4698 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004699
4700 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
4701 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004702};
4703
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004704/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004705/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4706/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4707/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4708/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4709/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4710/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004711///
4712/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004713bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004714BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4715 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004716
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004717 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004718 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004719 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004720
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004721 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004722 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004723 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004724 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004725 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004726 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004727 buildObjCPtr = true;
4728 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004729 else
4730 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4731 }
4732 else
4733 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004734
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004735 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4736 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4737 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4738 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4739 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4740 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004741 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004742 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004743 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004744 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4745 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004746
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004747 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4748 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4749 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004750 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4751 // in the types.
4752 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4753 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004754 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004755 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4756 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
4757 else
4758 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004759 }
4760
4761 return true;
4762}
4763
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004764/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4765/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4766/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4767/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4768/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4769/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4770/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004771///
4772/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004773bool
4774BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4775 QualType Ty) {
4776 // Insert this type.
4777 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4778 return false;
4779
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004780 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4781 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004782
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004783 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004784 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4785 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4786 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4787 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4788 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4789 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004790 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4791
4792 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4793 // qualifiers.
4794 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4795 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4796 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004797
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004798 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004799 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
4800 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004801 }
4802
4803 return true;
4804}
4805
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004806/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4807/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004808/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4809/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004810/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4811/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4812/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4813/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004814void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004815BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004816 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004817 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004818 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4819 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004820 // Only deal with canonical types.
4821 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4822
4823 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4824 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004825 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004826 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4827
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004828 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4829 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4830 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
4831
4832 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004833 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004834
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004835 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
4836 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
4837 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
4838
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004839 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
4840 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
4841 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
4842
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004843 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
4844 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
4845 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004846 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4847 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004848 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004849 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004850 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4851 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4852 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4853 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004854 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004855 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004856 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004857 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004858 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
4859 // extension.
4860 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004861 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004862 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
4863 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4864 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
4865 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004866
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004867 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
4868 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4869 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4870 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
4871 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
4872 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4873 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4874 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004875
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004876 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
4877 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
4878 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
4879 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004880
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004881 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4882 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
4883 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
4884 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004885 }
4886 }
4887 }
4888}
4889
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004890/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4891/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4892/// given type to the candidate set.
4893static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4894 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004895 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004896 unsigned NumArgs,
4897 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4898 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004899
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004900 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4901 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4902 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4903 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4904 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004905
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004906 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4907 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004908 ParamTypes[0]
4909 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004910 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4911 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004912 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004913 }
4914}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004915
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004916/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4917/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004918static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4919 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4920 const RecordType *TyRec;
4921 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4922 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004923 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004924 else
4925 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4926 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004927 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004928 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4929 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4930 return VRQuals;
4931 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004932
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004933 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004934 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4935 return VRQuals;
4936
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004937 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004938 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004939
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004940 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004941 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004942 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4943 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4944 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4945 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004946 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4947 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4948 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4949 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4950 // as see them.
4951 bool done = false;
4952 while (!done) {
4953 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4954 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004955 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004956 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4957 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4958 else
4959 done = true;
4960 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4961 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4962 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4963 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4964 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
4965 return VRQuals;
4966 }
4967 }
4968 }
4969 return VRQuals;
4970}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004971
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004972namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004973
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004974/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
4975/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
4976/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
4977/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
4978class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004979 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
4980 Sema &S;
4981 Expr **Args;
4982 unsigned NumArgs;
4983 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004984 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004985 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
4986 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004987
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004988 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
4989 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004990 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
4991 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004992 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
4993 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
4994 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
4995 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
4996 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
4997 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
4998 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
4999
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005000 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
5001 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
5002 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
5003 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5004 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5005 // Start of promoted types.
5006 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5007 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5008 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005009
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005010 // Start of integral types.
5011 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5012 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5013 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5014 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5015 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5016 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5017 // End of promoted types.
5018
5019 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5020 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5021 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5022 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5023 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5024 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5025 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5026 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5027 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5028 // End of integral types.
5029 // FIXME: What about complex?
5030 };
5031 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5032 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005033
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005034 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5035 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5036 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5037 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5038 // The rules are basically:
5039 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5040 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5041 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5042 // - use the larger type
5043 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5044 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5045 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5046 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5047 // better not to make any assumptions).
5048 enum PromotedType {
5049 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
5050 };
5051 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5052 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5053 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5054 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5055 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5056 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5057 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5058 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5059 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5060 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5061 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
5062 };
5063
5064 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5065 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5066 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5067
5068 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005069 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005070
5071 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5072 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005073 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5074 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005075 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5076 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5077
5078 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5079 if (LW > RW) return LT;
5080 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5081
5082 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5083 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5084 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5085 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5086 }
5087
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00005088 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5089 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005090 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5091 bool HasVolatile) {
5092 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5093 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5094 S.Context.IntTy
5095 };
5096
5097 // Non-volatile version.
5098 if (NumArgs == 1)
5099 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5100 else
5101 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5102
5103 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5104 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5105 if (HasVolatile) {
5106 ParamTypes[0] =
5107 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5108 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5109 if (NumArgs == 1)
5110 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5111 else
5112 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5113 }
5114 }
5115
5116public:
5117 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5118 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5119 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005120 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005121 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
5122 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5123 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5124 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005125 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5126 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005127 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5128 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5129 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005130 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005131 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005132 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5133 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005134 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005135 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5136 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005137 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005138 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5139 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005140 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5141 }
5142
5143 // C++ [over.built]p3:
5144 //
5145 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5146 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5147 // functions of the form
5148 //
5149 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
5150 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
5151 //
5152 // C++ [over.built]p4:
5153 //
5154 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5155 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5156 // candidate operator functions of the form
5157 //
5158 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
5159 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
5160 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005161 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5162 return;
5163
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005164 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5165 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5166 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005167 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005168 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5169 }
5170 }
5171
5172 // C++ [over.built]p5:
5173 //
5174 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5175 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5176 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5177 //
5178 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
5179 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
5180 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5181 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5182 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5183 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5184 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5185 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5186 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5187 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005188 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005189 continue;
5190
5191 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5192 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5193 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5194 }
5195 }
5196
5197 // C++ [over.built]p6:
5198 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5199 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5200 //
5201 // T& operator*(T*);
5202 //
5203 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005204 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005205 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005206 // T& operator*(T*);
5207 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5208 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5209 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5210 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5211 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5212 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5213 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005214 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5215 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005216
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005217 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5218 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5219 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005220
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005221 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5222 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5223 }
5224 }
5225
5226 // C++ [over.built]p9:
5227 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5228 // operator functions of the form
5229 //
5230 // T operator+(T);
5231 // T operator-(T);
5232 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005233 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5234 return;
5235
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005236 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5237 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005238 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005239 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5240 }
5241
5242 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5243 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5244 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5245 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5246 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5247 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5248 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5249 }
5250 }
5251
5252 // C++ [over.built]p8:
5253 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5254 // the form
5255 //
5256 // T* operator+(T*);
5257 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5258 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5259 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5260 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5261 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5262 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5263 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5264 }
5265 }
5266
5267 // C++ [over.built]p10:
5268 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5269 // operator functions of the form
5270 //
5271 // T operator~(T);
5272 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005273 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5274 return;
5275
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005276 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5277 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005278 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005279 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5280 }
5281
5282 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5283 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5284 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5285 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5286 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5287 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5288 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5289 }
5290 }
5291
5292 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5293 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5294 // functions of the form
5295 //
5296 // bool operator==(T,T);
5297 // bool operator!=(T,T);
5298 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5299 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5300 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5301
5302 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5303 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5304 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5305 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5306 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5307 ++MemPtr) {
5308 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5309 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5310 continue;
5311
5312 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5313 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5314 CandidateSet);
5315 }
5316 }
5317 }
5318
5319 // C++ [over.built]p15:
5320 //
5321 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
5322 // candidate operator functions of the form
5323 //
5324 // bool operator<(T, T);
5325 // bool operator>(T, T);
5326 // bool operator<=(T, T);
5327 // bool operator>=(T, T);
5328 // bool operator==(T, T);
5329 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005330 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5331 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5332 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5333 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5334 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5335 // functions.
5336 //
5337 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5338 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5339 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5340 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5341 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5342 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5343 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5344 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5345 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5346
5347 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5348 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5349 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5350 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5351 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5352 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5353 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5354 continue;
5355
5356 QualType FirstParamType =
5357 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5358 QualType SecondParamType =
5359 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5360
5361 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5362 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5363 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5364 continue;
5365
5366 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5367 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5368 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5369 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5370 }
5371 }
5372 }
5373
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005374 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5375 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5376
5377 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5378 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5379 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5380 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5381 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5382 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5383 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5384 continue;
5385
5386 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5387 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5388 CandidateSet);
5389 }
5390 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5391 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5392 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5393 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5394 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5395
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005396 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5397 // candidate exists.
5398 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5399 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5400 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005401 continue;
5402
5403 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005404 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5405 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005406 }
5407 }
5408 }
5409
5410 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5411 //
5412 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5413 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5414 //
5415 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5416 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5417 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5418 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5419 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5420 //
5421 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5422 //
5423 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5424 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5425 //
5426 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5427 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5428 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5429 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5430
5431 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5432 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5433 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5434 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5435 };
5436 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5437 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5438 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5439 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005440 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5441 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5442 continue;
5443
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005444 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5445 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5446 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5447 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5448 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5449 CandidateSet);
5450 }
5451 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5452 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5453 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5454 continue;
5455
5456 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5457 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5458 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5459 }
5460 }
5461 }
5462 }
5463
5464 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5465 //
5466 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5467 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5468 //
5469 // LR operator*(L, R);
5470 // LR operator/(L, R);
5471 // LR operator+(L, R);
5472 // LR operator-(L, R);
5473 // bool operator<(L, R);
5474 // bool operator>(L, R);
5475 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5476 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5477 // bool operator==(L, R);
5478 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5479 //
5480 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5481 // between types L and R.
5482 //
5483 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5484 //
5485 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5486 // candidate operator functions of the form
5487 //
5488 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5489 //
5490 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5491 // between types L and R.
5492 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5493 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005494 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5495 return;
5496
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005497 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5498 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5499 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5500 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005501 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5502 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005503 QualType Result =
5504 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005505 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005506 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5507 }
5508 }
5509
5510 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5511 // conditional operator for vector types.
5512 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5513 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5514 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5515 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5516 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5517 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5518 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5519 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5520 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5521 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5522 if (!isComparison) {
5523 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5524 Result = *Vec1;
5525 else
5526 Result = *Vec2;
5527 }
5528
5529 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5530 }
5531 }
5532 }
5533
5534 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5535 //
5536 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5537 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5538 //
5539 // LR operator%(L, R);
5540 // LR operator&(L, R);
5541 // LR operator^(L, R);
5542 // LR operator|(L, R);
5543 // L operator<<(L, R);
5544 // L operator>>(L, R);
5545 //
5546 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5547 // between types L and R.
5548 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005549 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5550 return;
5551
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005552 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5553 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5554 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5555 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005556 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5557 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005558 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5559 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005560 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005561 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5562 }
5563 }
5564 }
5565
5566 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5567 //
5568 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5569 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5570 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5571 //
5572 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5573 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5574 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5575 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5576
5577 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5578 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5579 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5580 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5581 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5582 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5583 continue;
5584
5585 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5586 CandidateSet);
5587 }
5588
5589 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5590 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5591 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5592 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5593 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5594 continue;
5595
5596 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5597 CandidateSet);
5598 }
5599 }
5600 }
5601
5602 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5603 //
5604 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5605 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5606 // of the form
5607 //
5608 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5609 //
5610 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5611 //
5612 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5613 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5614 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5615 //
5616 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5617 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5618 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5619 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5620 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5621
5622 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5623 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5624 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5625 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5626 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5627 if (isEqualOp)
5628 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005629 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5630 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005631
5632 // non-volatile version
5633 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5634 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5635 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5636 };
5637 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5638 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5639
5640 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5641 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5642 // volatile version
5643 ParamTypes[0] =
5644 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5645 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5646 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5647 }
5648 }
5649
5650 if (isEqualOp) {
5651 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5652 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5653 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5654 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5655 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5656 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5657 continue;
5658
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005659 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5660 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5661 *Ptr,
5662 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005663
5664 // non-volatile version
5665 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5666 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5667
5668 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5669 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5670 // volatile version
5671 ParamTypes[0] =
5672 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005673 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5674 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005675 }
5676 }
5677 }
5678 }
5679
5680 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5681 //
5682 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5683 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5684 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5685 // the form
5686 //
5687 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5688 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5689 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5690 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5691 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5692 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005693 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5694 return;
5695
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005696 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5697 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5698 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5699 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005700 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005701
5702 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5703 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005704 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005705 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5706 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5707
5708 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5709 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5710 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005711 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005712 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005713 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5714 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005715 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5716 }
5717 }
5718 }
5719
5720 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5721 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5722 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5723 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5724 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5725 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5726 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5727 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5728 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5729 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5730 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5731 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5732 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5733 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5734 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5735
5736 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5737 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5738 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5739 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005740 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5741 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005742 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5743 }
5744 }
5745 }
5746 }
5747
5748 // C++ [over.built]p22:
5749 //
5750 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
5751 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
5752 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5753 //
5754 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
5755 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
5756 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
5757 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
5758 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
5759 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
5760 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005761 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5762 return;
5763
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005764 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
5765 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5766 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5767 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005768 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005769
5770 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5771 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005772 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005773 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5774 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5775 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005776 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005777 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
5778 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
5779 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5780 CandidateSet);
5781 }
5782 }
5783 }
5784 }
5785
5786 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
5787 //
5788 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
5789 //
5790 // bool operator!(bool);
5791 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
5792 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
5793 void addExclaimOverload() {
5794 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
5795 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
5796 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5797 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
5798 }
5799 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
5800 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
5801 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5802 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5803 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
5804 }
5805
5806 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5807 //
5808 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
5809 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5810 //
5811 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5812 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5813 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5814 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5815 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5816 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
5817 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5818 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5819 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5820 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5821 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
5822 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005823 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5824 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005825
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005826 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5827
5828 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5829 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5830 }
5831
5832 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5833 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5834 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5835 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5836 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
5837 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005838 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5839 continue;
5840
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005841 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5842
5843 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
5844 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5845 }
5846 }
5847
5848 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5849 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5850 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5851 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5852 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5853 //
5854 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5855 //
5856 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5857 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
5858 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5859 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5860 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5861 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5862 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5863 QualType C1;
5864 QualifierCollector Q1;
5865 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
5866 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5867 continue;
5868 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5869 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5870 // volatile/restrict type.
5871 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5872 continue;
5873 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5874 continue;
5875 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5876 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
5877 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
5878 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5879 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5880 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
5881 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
5882 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5883 break;
5884 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5885 // build CV12 T&
5886 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
5887 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5888 T.isVolatileQualified())
5889 continue;
5890 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5891 T.isRestrictQualified())
5892 continue;
5893 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
5894 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5895 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5896 }
5897 }
5898 }
5899
5900 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5901 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5902 // therefore added as binary.
5903 //
5904 // C++ [over.built]p25:
5905 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
5906 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5907 //
5908 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5909 //
5910 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
5911 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5912 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5913
5914 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5915 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5916 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5917 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5918 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5919 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5920 continue;
5921
5922 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5923 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5924 }
5925
5926 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5927 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5928 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5929 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5930 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5931 continue;
5932
5933 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5934 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5935 }
5936
5937 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
5938 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5939 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5940 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5941 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5942 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
5943 continue;
5944
5945 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5946 continue;
5947
5948 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5949 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5950 }
5951 }
5952 }
5953 }
5954};
5955
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005956} // end anonymous namespace
5957
5958/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
5959/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
5960/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
5961/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
5962/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
5963void
5964Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5965 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5966 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5967 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005968 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
5969 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005970 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
5971 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005972 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
5973 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00005974 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5975 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005976
5977 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
5978 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005979 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
5980 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5981 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
5982 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
5983 OpLoc,
5984 true,
5985 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
5986 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
5987 Op == OO_PipePipe),
5988 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005989 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
5990 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
5991 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
5992 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
5993 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005994 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005995
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005996 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
5997 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
5998 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
5999 return;
6000
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006001 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
6002 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
6003 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006004 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006005 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
6006
6007 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006008 switch (Op) {
6009 case OO_None:
6010 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
6011 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
6012 break;
6013
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006014 case OO_New:
6015 case OO_Delete:
6016 case OO_Array_New:
6017 case OO_Array_Delete:
6018 case OO_Call:
6019 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
6020 break;
6021
6022 case OO_Comma:
6023 case OO_Arrow:
6024 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6025 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6026 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006027 break;
6028
6029 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006030 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006031 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006032 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006033
6034 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006035 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006036 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006037 } else {
6038 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6039 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6040 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006041 break;
6042
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006043 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006044 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006045 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6046 else
6047 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6048 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006049
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006050 case OO_Slash:
6051 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006052 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006053
6054 case OO_PlusPlus:
6055 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006056 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6057 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006058 break;
6059
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006060 case OO_EqualEqual:
6061 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006062 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006063 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006064
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006065 case OO_Less:
6066 case OO_Greater:
6067 case OO_LessEqual:
6068 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006069 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006070 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6071 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006072
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006073 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006074 case OO_Caret:
6075 case OO_Pipe:
6076 case OO_LessLess:
6077 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006078 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006079 break;
6080
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006081 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6082 if (NumArgs == 1)
6083 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6084 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6085 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6086 break;
6087
6088 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6089 break;
6090
6091 case OO_Tilde:
6092 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6093 break;
6094
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006095 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006096 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006097 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006098
6099 case OO_PlusEqual:
6100 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006101 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006102 // Fall through.
6103
6104 case OO_StarEqual:
6105 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006106 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006107 break;
6108
6109 case OO_PercentEqual:
6110 case OO_LessLessEqual:
6111 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6112 case OO_AmpEqual:
6113 case OO_CaretEqual:
6114 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006115 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006116 break;
6117
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006118 case OO_Exclaim:
6119 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006120 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006121
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006122 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006123 case OO_PipePipe:
6124 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006125 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006126
6127 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006128 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006129 break;
6130
6131 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006132 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006133 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006134
6135 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006136 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006137 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6138 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006139 }
6140}
6141
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006142/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6143/// to the set of overloading candidates.
6144///
6145/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6146/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6147/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6148/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006149void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006150Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006151 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006152 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006153 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006154 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6155 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006156 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006157
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00006158 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6159 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6160 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
6161 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6162 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
6163 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6164
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006165 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006166 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006167
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006168 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006169 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6170 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6171 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006172 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006173 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006174 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006175 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006176 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006177
6178 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6179 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006180 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006181 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006182 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006183 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006184 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006185
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006186 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006187 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006188 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006189 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006190 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00006191 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006192 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006193}
6194
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006195/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6196/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006197bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006198isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006199 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6200 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006201 SourceLocation Loc,
6202 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006203 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6204 // functions.
6205 if (!Cand2.Viable)
6206 return Cand1.Viable;
6207 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6208 return false;
6209
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006210 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6211 //
6212 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6213 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6214 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6215 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6216 unsigned StartArg = 0;
6217 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6218 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006219
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006220 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006221 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6222 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006223 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006224 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6225 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6226 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006227 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006228 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6229 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006230 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6231 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6232 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6233 HasBetterConversion = true;
6234 break;
6235
6236 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6237 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6238 return false;
6239
6240 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6241 // Do nothing.
6242 break;
6243 }
6244 }
6245
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006246 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006247 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006248 if (HasBetterConversion)
6249 return true;
6250
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006251 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006252 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00006253 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006254 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6255 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006256
6257 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6258 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6259 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006260 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00006261 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006262 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006263 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006264 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6265 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6266 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006267 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00006268 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006269 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006270 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006271 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006272
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006273 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6274 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6275 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6276 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6277 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6278 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006279 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006280 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006281 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006282 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6283 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006284 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6285 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6286 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6287 return true;
6288
6289 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6290 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6291 return false;
6292
6293 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6294 // Do nothing
6295 break;
6296 }
6297 }
6298
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006299 return false;
6300}
6301
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006302/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006303/// within an overload candidate set.
6304///
6305/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6306///
6307/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6308/// which overload resolution occurs.
6309///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006310/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006311/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6312///
6313/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006314OverloadingResult
6315OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006316 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00006317 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006318 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006319 Best = end();
6320 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6321 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006322 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006323 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006324 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006325 }
6326
6327 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006328 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006329 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6330
6331 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6332 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006333 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006334 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006335 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006336 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006337 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006338 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006339 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006340 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006341 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006342
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006343 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006344 if (Best->Function &&
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006345 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || Best->Function->isUnavailable()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006346 return OR_Deleted;
6347
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006348 return OR_Success;
6349}
6350
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006351namespace {
6352
6353enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6354 oc_function,
6355 oc_method,
6356 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006357 oc_function_template,
6358 oc_method_template,
6359 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006360 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6361 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006362 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
6363 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006364};
6365
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006366OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6367 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6368 std::string &Description) {
6369 bool isTemplate = false;
6370
6371 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6372 isTemplate = true;
6373 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6374 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6375 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006376
6377 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006378 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006379 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006380
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006381 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6382 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6383
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006384 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
6385 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006386 }
6387
6388 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6389 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6390 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006391 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006392 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006393
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006394 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006395 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006396 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6397 }
6398
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006399 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006400}
6401
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006402void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6403 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6404 if (!Ctor) return;
6405
6406 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6407 if (!Ctor) return;
6408
6409 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6410}
6411
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006412} // end anonymous namespace
6413
6414// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6415void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006416 std::string FnDesc;
6417 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6418 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6419 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006420 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006421}
6422
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00006423//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6424// OverloadedExpr
6425void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6426 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6427
6428 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6429 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6430
6431 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6432 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6433 I != IEnd; ++I) {
6434 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
6435 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6436 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
6437 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
6438 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6439 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
6440 }
6441 }
6442}
6443
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006444/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6445/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6446/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006447void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6448 Sema &S,
6449 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6450 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6451 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6452 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006453 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006454 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6455 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006456 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006457}
6458
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006459namespace {
6460
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006461void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6462 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6463 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006464 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6465 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6466
6467 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6468 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6469 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006470 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006471 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006472 if (I == 0)
6473 isObjectArgument = true;
6474 else
6475 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006476 }
6477
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006478 std::string FnDesc;
6479 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6480
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006481 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6482 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6483 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006484
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006485 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006486 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006487 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6488 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6489 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006490 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006491
6492 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6493 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6494 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6495 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006496 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006497 return;
6498 }
6499
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006500 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6501 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006502 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6503 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6504 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6505 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6506 else {
6507 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6508 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6509 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6510 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6511 }
6512
6513 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6514 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6515 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6516 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6517 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6518 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6519 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6520
6521 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6522 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6523
6524 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6525 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6526 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6527 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6528 << FromTy
6529 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6530 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006531 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006532 return;
6533 }
6534
6535 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6536 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6537
6538 if (isObjectArgument) {
6539 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6540 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6541 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6542 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6543 } else {
6544 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6545 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6546 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6547 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6548 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006549 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006550 return;
6551 }
6552
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006553 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6554 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6555 // the failure.
6556 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6557 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6558 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6559 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6560 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6561 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6562 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6563 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006564 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006565 return;
6566 }
6567
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006568 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006569 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006570 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6571 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6572 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6573 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6574 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6575 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006576 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006577 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006578 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006579 }
6580 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6581 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6582 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6583 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6584 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6585 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6586 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6587 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6588 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006589 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6590 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6591 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6592 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6593 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6594 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6595 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6596 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006597
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006598 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006599 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006600 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006601 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6602 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006603 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006604 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006605 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006606 return;
6607 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006608
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006609 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006610 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
6611 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006612 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00006613 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006614 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006615}
6616
6617void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6618 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
6619 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
6620
6621 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6622 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6623
6624 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006625
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006626 // at least / at most / exactly
6627 unsigned mode, modeCount;
6628 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006629 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
6630 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6631 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006632 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00006633 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006634 mode = 0; // "at least"
6635 else
6636 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6637 modeCount = MinParams;
6638 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006639 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
6640 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6641 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006642 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
6643 mode = 1; // "at most"
6644 else
6645 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6646 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
6647 }
6648
6649 std::string Description;
6650 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
6651
6652 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006653 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006654 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006655 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006656}
6657
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006658/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
6659void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6660 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6661 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
6662
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006663 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006664 NamedDecl *ParamD;
6665 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
6666 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
6667 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006668 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
6669 case Sema::TDK_Success:
6670 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
6671
6672 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006673 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
6674 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
6675 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006676 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006677 return;
6678 }
6679
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006680 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
6681 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
6682 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
6683
6684 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
6685
6686 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
6687 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006688 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006689 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006690 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006691 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
6692
6693 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
6694 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
6695 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
6696 // done on dependent types).
6697 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
6698
6699 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
6700 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006701 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006702 return;
6703 }
6704
6705 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006706 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006707 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006708 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006709 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006710 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006711 which = 1;
6712 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006713 which = 2;
6714 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006715
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006716 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006717 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006718 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
6719 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006720 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006721 return;
6722 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006723
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006724 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006725 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006726 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006727 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006728 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
6729 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6730 else {
6731 int index = 0;
6732 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
6733 index = TTP->getIndex();
6734 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
6735 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
6736 index = NTTP->getIndex();
6737 else
6738 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006739 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006740 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
6741 << (index + 1);
6742 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006743 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006744 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006745
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006746 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
6747 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
6748 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
6749 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006750
6751 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
6752 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006753 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006754 return;
6755
6756 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
6757 std::string ArgString;
6758 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
6759 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
6760 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6761 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
6762 *Args);
6763 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
6764 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006765 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006766 return;
6767 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006768
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006769 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
6770 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006771 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006772 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
6773 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006774 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006775 return;
6776 }
6777}
6778
6779/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
6780/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
6781///
6782/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
6783/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
6784/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
6785/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
6786/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
6787/// overload.
6788///
6789/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
6790/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
6791/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006792void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6793 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006794 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6795
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006796 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006797 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->isUnavailable())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006798 std::string FnDesc;
6799 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006800
6801 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006802 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006803 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006804 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006805 }
6806
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006807 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
6808 if (Cand->Viable) {
6809 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
6810 return;
6811 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006812
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006813 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
6814 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
6815 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
6816 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006817
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006818 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006819 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
6820
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006821 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
6822 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006823 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006824 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006825
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006826 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
6827 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
6828 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006829 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
6830 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006831
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006832 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
6833 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
6834 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
6835 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006836 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006837 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006838}
6839
6840void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6841 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
6842 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
6843 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
6844 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
6845 bool isLValueReference = false;
6846 bool isRValueReference = false;
6847 bool isPointer = false;
6848 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6849 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
6850 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6851 isLValueReference = true;
6852 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6853 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
6854 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6855 isRValueReference = true;
6856 }
6857 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6858 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6859 isPointer = true;
6860 }
6861 // Desugar down to a function type.
6862 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
6863 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
6864 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
6865 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
6866 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
6867
6868 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
6869 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006870 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006871}
6872
6873void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
6874 const char *Opc,
6875 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6876 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6877 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
6878 std::string TypeStr("operator");
6879 TypeStr += Opc;
6880 TypeStr += "(";
6881 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
6882 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
6883 TypeStr += ")";
6884 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6885 } else {
6886 TypeStr += ", ";
6887 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
6888 TypeStr += ")";
6889 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6890 }
6891}
6892
6893void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6894 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6895 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
6896 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
6897 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006898 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
6899 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
6900
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006901 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006902 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006903 }
6904}
6905
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006906SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6907 if (Cand->Function)
6908 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006909 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006910 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
6911 return SourceLocation();
6912}
6913
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006914struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
6915 Sema &S;
6916 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006917
6918 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
6919 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006920 // Fast-path this check.
6921 if (L == R) return false;
6922
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006923 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006924 if (L->Viable) {
6925 if (!R->Viable) return true;
6926
6927 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
6928 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
6929 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006930 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
6931 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006932 } else if (R->Viable)
6933 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006934
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006935 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006936
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006937 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
6938 if (!L->Viable) {
6939 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
6940 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6941 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6942 return false;
6943 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6944 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6945 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006946
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006947 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
6948 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
6949 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
6950 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6951 return true;
6952
6953 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
6954 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
6955 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
6956
6957 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00006958 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
6959 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006960 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6961 L->Conversions[I],
6962 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006963 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6964 leftBetter++;
6965 break;
6966
6967 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6968 leftBetter--;
6969 break;
6970
6971 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6972 break;
6973 }
6974 }
6975 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
6976 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
6977
6978 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6979 return false;
6980
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006981 // TODO: others?
6982 }
6983
6984 // Sort everything else by location.
6985 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
6986 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
6987
6988 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
6989 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
6990 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
6991
6992 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006993 }
6994};
6995
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006996/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
6997/// computes up to the first
6998void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6999 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7000 assert(!Cand->Viable);
7001
7002 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
7003 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
7004
7005 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007006 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007007 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
7008 while (true) {
7009 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7010 ConvIdx++;
7011 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
7012 break;
7013 }
7014
7015 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7016 return;
7017
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007018 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7019 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7020
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00007021 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007022 // operation somehow.
7023 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007024
7025 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7026 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7027
7028 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7029 QualType ConvType
7030 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7031 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7032 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7033 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7034 ArgIdx--;
7035 } else if (Cand->Function) {
7036 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7037 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7038 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7039 ArgIdx--;
7040 } else {
7041 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7042 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7043 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7044 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007045 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7046 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007047 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007048 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007049 return;
7050 }
7051
7052 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7053 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7054 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
7055 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
7056 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007057 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007058 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007059 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007060 else
7061 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7062 }
7063}
7064
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007065} // end anonymous namespace
7066
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007067/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7068/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007069/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007070void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7071 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7072 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7073 const char *Opc,
7074 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007075 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
7076 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
7077 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007078 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7079 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007080 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007081 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007082 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007083 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007084 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7085 Cands.push_back(Cand);
7086 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
7087 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007088 }
7089 }
7090
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007091 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007092 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007093
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007094 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007095
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007096 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007097 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007098 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007099 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7100 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00007101
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007102 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7103 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7104 // candidate list.
7105 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
7106 break;
7107 }
7108 ++CandsShown;
7109
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007110 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007111 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007112 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007113 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007114 else {
7115 assert(Cand->Viable &&
7116 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007117 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7118 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7119 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7120 //
7121 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7122 // different ambiguities, though.
7123 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007124 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007125 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7126 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007127
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007128 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007129 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007130 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007131 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007132
7133 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007134 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007135}
7136
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007137// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
7138// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7139// R (A) --> R(A)
7140// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7141// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7142// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7143QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7144 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7145 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7146 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7147 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7148 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7149 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7150 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007151 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007152 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7153 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7154 Ret =
7155 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7156 return Ret;
7157}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007158
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007159// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7160// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7161class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7162{
7163 Sema& S;
7164 Expr* SourceExpr;
7165 const QualType& TargetType;
7166 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7167
7168 bool Complain;
7169 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7170 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007171
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007172 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7173 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007174
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007175 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7176 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7177 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007178 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007179
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007180public:
7181 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7182 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7183 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7184 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7185 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7186 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7187 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7188 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7189 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7190 {
7191 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7192
7193 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7194 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7195 DeclAccessPair dap;
7196 if( FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7197 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00007198
7199 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7200 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7201 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7202 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7203 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7204 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7205
7206 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7207 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7208 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7209 return;
7210 }
7211 }
7212
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007213 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7214 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007215 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007216 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007217 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007218
7219 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7220 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007221
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007222 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7223 // C++ [over.over]p4:
7224 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
7225 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7226 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7227 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7228 else
7229 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7230 }
7231 }
7232 }
7233
7234private:
7235 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7236 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7237 }
7238
7239 // [ToType] [Return]
7240
7241 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7242 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7243 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7244 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7245 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7246 }
7247
7248 // return true if any matching specializations were found
7249 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7250 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7251 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7252 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7253 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7254 // static when converting to member pointer.
7255 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7256 return false;
7257 }
7258 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7259 return false;
7260
7261 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7262 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7263 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7264 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7265 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7266 // overloaded functions considered.
7267 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7268 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7269 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7270 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7271 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7272 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7273 Info)) {
7274 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7275 (void)Result;
7276 return false;
7277 }
7278
7279 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
7280 // This function template specicalization works.
7281 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
7282 assert(TargetFunctionType
7283 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
7284 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
7285 return true;
7286 }
7287
7288 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
7289 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007290 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007291 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
7292 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007293 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7294 return false;
7295 }
7296 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7297 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007298
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007299 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007300 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007301 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
7302 FunDecl->getType()) ||
7303 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007304 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007305 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
7306 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007307 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007308 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007309 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007310 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007311
7312 return false;
7313 }
7314
7315 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
7316 bool Ret = false;
7317
7318 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
7319 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
7320 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7321 return false;
7322
7323 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7324 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7325 I != E; ++I) {
7326 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
7327 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
7328
7329 // C++ [over.over]p3:
7330 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
7331 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
7332 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
7333 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
7334 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
7335 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7336 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
7337 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
7338 Ret = true;
7339 }
7340 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
7341 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
7342 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
7343 Ret = true;
7344 }
7345 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
7346 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007347 }
7348
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007349 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007350 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
7351 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
7352 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
7353 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
7354 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
7355
7356 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
7357 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
7358 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
7359 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007360
7361 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
7362 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
7363 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007364
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007365 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007366 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
7367 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
7368 S.PDiag(),
7369 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7370 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
7371 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7372 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
7373 Complain);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007374
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007375 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
7376 // Make it the first and only element
7377 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
7378 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
7379 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007380 }
7381 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007382
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007383 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
7384 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
7385 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
7386 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
7387 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
7388 ++I;
7389 else {
7390 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
7391 Matches.set_size(N);
7392 }
7393 }
7394 }
7395
7396public:
7397 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
7398 assert(Matches.empty());
7399 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
7400 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
7401 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7402 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7403 }
7404
7405 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7406 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
7407 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
7408 }
7409
7410 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7411 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
7412 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
7413 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
7414 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
7415 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7416 }
7417
7418 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
7419 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
7420 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
7421 }
7422
7423 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
7424 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
7425 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7426 << OvlExpr->getName()
7427 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7428 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7429 }
7430
7431 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
7432
7433 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
7434 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7435 return Matches[0].second;
7436 }
7437
7438 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
7439 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7440 return &Matches[0].first;
7441 }
7442};
7443
7444/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
7445/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
7446/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
7447/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
7448///
7449/// @code
7450/// int f(double);
7451/// int f(int);
7452///
7453/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
7454/// @endcode
7455///
7456/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
7457/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
7458/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
7459FunctionDecl *
7460Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
7461 bool Complain,
7462 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
7463
7464 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7465
7466 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
7467 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
7468 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
7469 if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
7470 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7471 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
7472 else
7473 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
7474 }
7475 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
7476 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
7477 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
7478 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
7479 assert(Fn);
7480 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
7481 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007482 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007483 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00007484 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007485
7486 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007487}
7488
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007489/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007490/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
7491///
7492/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
7493/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007494/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007495/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007496FunctionDecl *Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Expr *From,
7497 bool Complain,
7498 DeclAccessPair* FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007499 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7500 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
7501 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007502 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7503 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
7504 // operator.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007505 if (From->getType() != Context.OverloadTy)
7506 return 0;
7507
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007508 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).Expression;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007509
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007510 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007511 if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007512 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007513
7514 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
7515 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007516
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007517 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
7518 // whose type matches exactly.
7519 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007520 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7521 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007522 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
7523 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007524 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
7525 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
7526 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007527 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007528 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7529 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007530
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007531 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7532 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7533 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7534 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7535 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7536 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007537 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007538 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007539 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7540 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7541 Specialization, Info)) {
7542 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7543 (void)Result;
7544 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007545 }
7546
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007547 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007548 if (Matched) {
7549 if (FoundResult)
7550 *FoundResult = DeclAccessPair();
7551
7552 if (Complain) {
7553 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7554 << OvlExpr->getName();
7555 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7556 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007557 return 0;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007558 }
7559
7560 if ((Matched = Specialization) && FoundResult)
7561 *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007562 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007563
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007564 return Matched;
7565}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007566
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007567
7568
7569
7570// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that
7571// can be resolved because it identifies a single function
7572// template specialization
7573// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
7574ExprResult Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7575 Expr *SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion, bool Complain,
7576 const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
7577 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
7578 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining ) {
7579
7580 assert(SrcExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7581
7582 DeclAccessPair Found;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007583 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007584 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7585 SrcExpr, false, // false -> Complain
7586 &Found)) {
7587 if (!DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, SrcExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin())) {
7588 // mark the expression as resolved to Fn
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007589 SingleFunctionExpression = Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr,
7590 Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007591 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007592 SingleFunctionExpression =
7593 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007594 }
7595 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007596 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007597 if (Complain) {
7598 OverloadExpr* oe = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression;
7599 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
7600 << oe->getName() << DestTypeForComplaining << OpRangeForComplaining
7601 << oe->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
7602 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr);
7603 }
7604 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007605 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007606
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007607 return SingleFunctionExpression;
7608}
7609
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007610/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
7611static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007612 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007613 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007614 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7615 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7616 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007617 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007618 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
7619 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
7620
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007621 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007622 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007623 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007624 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007625 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007626 }
7627
7628 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
7629 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007630 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
7631 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007632 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007633 return;
7634 }
7635
7636 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
7637
7638 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007639}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007640
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007641/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
7642/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007643void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007644 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7645 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7646 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007647
7648#ifndef NDEBUG
7649 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
7650 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007651 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007652 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
7653 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
7654 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
7655 //
7656 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
7657 //
7658 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007659 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007660 //
7661 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
7662 // template
7663 //
7664 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007665
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007666 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7667 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7668 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7669 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
7670 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
7671 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
7672 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007673 }
7674 }
7675#endif
7676
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007677 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
7678 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007679 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007680 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7681 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7682 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7683 }
7684
7685 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7686 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007687 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007688 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007689 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007690
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007691 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007692 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
7693 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007694 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007695 CandidateSet,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007696 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007697}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007698
7699/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
7700///
7701/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007702static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007703BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007704 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
7705 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7706 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007707 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007708
7709 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007710 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007711
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007712 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7713 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7714 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7715 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7716 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7717 }
7718
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007719 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
7720 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00007721 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007722 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007723
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007724 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
7725
7726 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
7727 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007728 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007729 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007730 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
7731 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007732 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7733 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
7734 else
7735 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
7736
7737 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007738 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007739
7740 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
7741 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
7742 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007743 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007744 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007745}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00007746
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007747/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007748/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
7749/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
7750/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
7751/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00007752/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007753/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007754ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007755Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007756 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7757 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007758 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7759 Expr *ExecConfig) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007760#ifndef NDEBUG
7761 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7762 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
7763 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
7764
7765 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
7766 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
7767 FunctionDecl *F;
7768 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
7769 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
7770 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
7771 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007772
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007773 // We don't perform ADL in C.
7774 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
7775 }
7776#endif
7777
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007778 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00007779
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007780 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
7781 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
7782 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007783
7784 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
7785 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
7786 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007787 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007788 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007789 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007790
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007791 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007792 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007793 case OR_Success: {
7794 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007795 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007796 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007797 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
7798 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007799 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007800 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
7801 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007802 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007803
7804 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00007805 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007806 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007807 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007808 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007809 break;
7810
7811 case OR_Ambiguous:
7812 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007813 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007814 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007815 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007816
7817 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007818 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007819 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
7820 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7821 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00007822 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007823 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007824 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
7825 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007826 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007827 }
7828
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007829 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007830 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007831}
7832
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007833static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00007834 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
7835 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
7836}
7837
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007838/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7839/// operator.
7840///
7841/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
7842///
7843/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7844/// operator.
7845///
7846/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7847/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7848/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7849/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7850/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7851/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
7852///
7853/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007854ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007855Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
7856 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007857 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007858 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007859
7860 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7861 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
7862 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007863 // TODO: provide better source location info.
7864 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007865
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007866 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7867 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
7868 if (Result.isInvalid())
7869 return ExprError();
7870 Input = Result.take();
7871 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007872
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007873 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
7874 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007875
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007876 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
7877 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
7878 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007879 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007880 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00007881 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
7882 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007883 NumArgs = 2;
7884 }
7885
7886 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007887 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007888 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007889 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007890 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007891 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007892 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007893
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007894 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007895 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007896 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007897 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007898 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7899 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007900 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007901 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007902 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007903 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007904 OpLoc));
7905 }
7906
7907 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007908 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007909
7910 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007911 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007912
7913 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7914 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
7915
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007916 // Add candidates from ADL.
7917 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00007918 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007919 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7920 CandidateSet);
7921
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007922 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007923 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007924
7925 // Perform overload resolution.
7926 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007927 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007928 case OR_Success: {
7929 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7930 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007931
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007932 if (FnDecl) {
7933 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7934 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007935
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007936 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
7937
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007938 // Convert the arguments.
7939 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007940 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007941
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007942 ExprResult InputRes =
7943 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7944 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
7945 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007946 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007947 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007948 } else {
7949 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007950 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007951 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007952 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00007953 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007954 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007955 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007956 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007957 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007958 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007959 }
7960
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007961 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
7962
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007963 // Determine the result type.
7964 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7965 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7966 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007967
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007968 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007969 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
7970 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
7971 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007972
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00007973 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007974 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007975 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007976 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007977
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007978 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00007979 FnDecl))
7980 return ExprError();
7981
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007982 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007983 } else {
7984 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7985 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7986 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007987 ExprResult InputRes =
7988 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
7989 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
7990 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
7991 return ExprError();
7992 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007993 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007994 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007995 }
7996
7997 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
7998 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
7999 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
8000 break;
8001
8002 case OR_Ambiguous:
8003 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8004 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8005 << Input->getType()
8006 << Input->getSourceRange();
8007 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
8008 Args, NumArgs,
8009 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8010 return ExprError();
8011
8012 case OR_Deleted:
8013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8014 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8015 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8016 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8017 << Input->getSourceRange();
8018 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8019 return ExprError();
8020 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008021
8022 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8023 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8024 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008025 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008026}
8027
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008028/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8029/// operator.
8030///
8031/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8032///
8033/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8034/// operator.
8035///
8036/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8037/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8038/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8039/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8040/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8041/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8042///
8043/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8044/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008045ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008046Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008047 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008048 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008049 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008050 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008051 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008052
8053 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8054 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8055 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8056
8057 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8058 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008059 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008060 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008061 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008062 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008063 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008064 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008065 Context.DependentTy,
8066 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8067 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008068
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008069 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8070 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008071 VK_LValue,
8072 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008073 Context.DependentTy,
8074 Context.DependentTy,
8075 OpLoc));
8076 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008077
8078 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008079 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008080 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8081 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008082 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008083 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8084 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8085 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008086 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008087 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008088 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008089 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008090 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008091 OpLoc));
8092 }
8093
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008094 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008095 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8096 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8097 if (Result.isInvalid())
8098 return ExprError();
8099 Args[1] = Result.take();
8100 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008101
8102 // The LHS is more complicated.
8103 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8104
8105 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
8106 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
8107 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
8108 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
8109
8110 // Is the property "logically" settable?
8111 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
8112 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
8113
8114 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
8115 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
8116 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
8117 // load and hope.
8118 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
8119 // we really should use the primitive.
8120 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
8121 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
8122 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
8123 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
8124 if (Settable)
8125 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8126 }
8127
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008128 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8129 if (Result.isInvalid())
8130 return ExprError();
8131 Args[0] = Result.take();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008132 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008133
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00008134 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
8135 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
8136 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
8137 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
8138 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
8139 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008140 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008141 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008142
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008143 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
8144 // create a built-in binary operator.
8145 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
8146 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8147
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008148 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008149 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008150
8151 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008152 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008153
8154 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8155 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8156
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008157 // Add candidates from ADL.
8158 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8159 Args, 2,
8160 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8161 CandidateSet);
8162
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008163 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008164 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008165
8166 // Perform overload resolution.
8167 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008168 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008169 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008170 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8171 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8172
8173 if (FnDecl) {
8174 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8175 // operator.
8176
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008177 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8178
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008179 // Convert the arguments.
8180 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008181 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008182 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008183
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008184 ExprResult Arg1 =
8185 PerformCopyInitialization(
8186 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8187 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8188 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008189 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008190 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008191
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008192 ExprResult Arg0 =
8193 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8194 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8195 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008196 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008197 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008198 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008199 } else {
8200 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008201 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
8202 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8203 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8204 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008205 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008206 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008207
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008208 ExprResult Arg1 =
8209 PerformCopyInitialization(
8210 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8211 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
8212 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008213 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
8214 return ExprError();
8215 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
8216 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008217 }
8218
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008219 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8220
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008221 // Determine the result type.
8222 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8223 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8224 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008225
8226 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008227 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
8228 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8229 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008230
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008231 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008232 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008233 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008234
8235 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008236 FnDecl))
8237 return ExprError();
8238
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008239 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008240 } else {
8241 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8242 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8243 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008244 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8245 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8246 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8247 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008248 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008249 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008250
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008251 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8252 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8253 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8254 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8255 return ExprError();
8256 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008257 break;
8258 }
8259 }
8260
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008261 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8262 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
8263 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
8264 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
8265 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008266 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008267 break;
8268
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008269 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
8270 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
8271 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008272 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008273 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008274 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008275 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
8276 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008277 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008278 } else {
8279 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
8280 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
8281 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008282 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008283 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008284 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
8285 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008286 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8287 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008288 return move(Result);
8289 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008290
8291 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008292 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008293 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008294 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008295 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008296 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8297 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008298 return ExprError();
8299
8300 case OR_Deleted:
8301 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8302 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8303 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008304 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008305 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008306 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008307 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008308 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008309
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008310 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008311 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008312}
8313
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008314ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008315Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
8316 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008317 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
8318 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008319 DeclarationName OpName =
8320 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
8321
8322 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8323 // expression.
8324 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8325
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008326 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008327 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
8328 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
8329 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008330 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008331 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008332 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008333 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
8334 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
8335 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008336 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008337
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008338 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
8339 Args, 2,
8340 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008341 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008342 RLoc));
8343 }
8344
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008345 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8346 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8347 if (Result.isInvalid())
8348 return ExprError();
8349 Args[0] = Result.take();
8350 }
8351 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8352 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8353 if (Result.isInvalid())
8354 return ExprError();
8355 Args[1] = Result.take();
8356 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008357
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008358 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008359 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008360
8361 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
8362
8363 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8364 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8365
8366 // Add builtin operator candidates.
8367 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8368
8369 // Perform overload resolution.
8370 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008371 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008372 case OR_Success: {
8373 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8374 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8375
8376 if (FnDecl) {
8377 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8378 // operator.
8379
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008380 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
8381
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008382 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008383 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008384
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008385 // Convert the arguments.
8386 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008387 ExprResult Arg0 =
8388 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8389 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8390 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008391 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008392 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008393
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008394 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008395 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008396 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008397 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008398 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008399 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008400 Owned(Args[1]));
8401 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
8402 return ExprError();
8403
8404 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
8405
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008406 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008407 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8408 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8409 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008410
8411 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008412 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc);
8413 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8414 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008415
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008416 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8417 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008418 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008419 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008420
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008421 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008422 FnDecl))
8423 return ExprError();
8424
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008425 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008426 } else {
8427 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8428 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8429 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008430 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8431 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8432 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8433 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008434 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008435 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
8436
8437 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8438 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8439 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8440 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8441 return ExprError();
8442 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008443
8444 break;
8445 }
8446 }
8447
8448 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008449 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8450 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8451 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
8452 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
8453 else
8454 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
8455 << Args[0]->getType()
8456 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008457 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8458 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008459 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008460 }
8461
8462 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008463 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008464 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008465 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
8466 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008467 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8468 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008469 return ExprError();
8470
8471 case OR_Deleted:
8472 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8473 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008474 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008475 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008476 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8477 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008478 return ExprError();
8479 }
8480
8481 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008482 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008483}
8484
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008485/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
8486/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
8487/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
8488/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
8489/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
8490/// expression refers to a member function or an overloaded member
8491/// function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008492ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008493Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
8494 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008495 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008496 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
8497 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008498 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008499
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008500 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008501 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00008502 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008503 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008504 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
8505 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008506 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008507 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008508 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008509 } else {
8510 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008511 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008512
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008513 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008514 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
8515 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
8516 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008517
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008518 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008519 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008520
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008521 // FIXME: avoid copy.
8522 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
8523 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8524 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8525 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
8526 }
8527
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008528 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
8529 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8530
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008531 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
8532 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
8533 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
8534 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
8535
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008536
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +00008537 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
8538 if (getLangOptions().Microsoft && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
8539 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
8540 CandidateSet);
8541 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008542 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
8543 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008544 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008545 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008546
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008547 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008548 ObjectClassification,
8549 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008550 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008551 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008552 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008553 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008554 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008555 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008556 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008557 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008558 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008559
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008560 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
8561
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008562 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008563 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008564 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008565 case OR_Success:
8566 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008567 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008568 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008569 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008570 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008571 break;
8572
8573 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008574 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008575 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008576 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008577 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008578 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008579 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008580
8581 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008582 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008583 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008584 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008585 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008586 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008587
8588 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008589 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008590 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008591 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008592 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008593 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008594 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008595 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008596 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008597 }
8598
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008599 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008600
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008601 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
8602 // non-member call based on that function.
8603 if (Method->isStatic()) {
8604 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
8605 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
8606 }
8607
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008608 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008609 }
8610
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008611 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
8612 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
8613 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8614
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008615 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008616 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008617 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008618 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008619
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00008620 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008621 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008622 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008623 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008624
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008625 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008626 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
8627 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008628 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8629 ExprResult ObjectArg =
8630 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
8631 FoundDecl, Method);
8632 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
8633 return ExprError();
8634 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
8635 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008636
8637 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008638 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8639 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008640 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008641 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008642 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008643
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008644 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008645 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00008646
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008647 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008648}
8649
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008650/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
8651/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
8652/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
8653/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008654ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008655Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00008656 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008657 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008658 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008659 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
8660 if (Object.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8661 Object = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object.take());
8662 if (Object.isInvalid())
8663 return ExprError();
8664 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008665
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008666 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
8667 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008668
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008669 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
8670 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00008671 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008672 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
8673 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
8674 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
8675 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008676 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00008677 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008678
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008679 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008680 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008681 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008682 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008683
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008684 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8685 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
8686 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8687
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008688 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008689 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008690 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
8691 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00008692 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008693 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008694
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008695 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
8696 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
8697 // form
8698 //
8699 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
8700 //
8701 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
8702 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00008703 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
8704 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
8705 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
8706 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008707 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
8708 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
8709 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
8710 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
8711 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008712 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00008713 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008714 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008715 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008716 NamedDecl *D = *I;
8717 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
8718 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8719 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008720
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008721 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
8722 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008723 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008724 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008725
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008726 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008727
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008728 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
8729 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
8730 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8731 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8732 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008733
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008734 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008735 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008736 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008737 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008738
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008739 // Perform overload resolution.
8740 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008741 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008742 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008743 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008744 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
8745 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008746 break;
8747
8748 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008749 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008750 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8751 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
8752 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008753 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008754 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008755 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008756 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008757 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008758 break;
8759
8760 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008761 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008762 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008763 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008764 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008765 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008766
8767 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008768 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008769 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
8770 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008771 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008772 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008773 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008774 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008775 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008776 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008777
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008778 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008779 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008780
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008781 if (Best->Function == 0) {
8782 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
8783 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008784 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008785 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
8786 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
8787
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008788 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008789 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008790
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008791 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
8792 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
8793 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008794
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00008795 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008796 // and then call it.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008797 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, Conv);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008798 if (Call.isInvalid())
8799 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008800
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008801 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008802 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008803 }
8804
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008805 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008806 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008807 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008808
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008809 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
8810 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
8811 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
8812 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008813 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8814 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008815
8816 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8817 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
8818
8819 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
8820 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
8821 // list).
8822 Expr **MethodArgs;
8823 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
8824 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8825 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
8826 } else {
8827 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
8828 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008829 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008830 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
8831 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008832
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008833 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
8834 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
8835 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008836
8837 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
8838 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008839 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8840 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8841 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8842
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008843 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008844 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008845 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008846 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008847 delete [] MethodArgs;
8848
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008849 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00008850 Method))
8851 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008852
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008853 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
8854 // slots in the call for them.
8855 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00008856 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008857 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
8858 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8859
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008860 bool IsError = false;
8861
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008862 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008863 ExprResult ObjRes =
8864 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
8865 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8866 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
8867 IsError = true;
8868 else
8869 Object = move(ObjRes);
8870 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008871
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008872 // Check the argument types.
8873 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008874 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008875 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008876 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008877
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008878 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008879
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008880 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008881 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008882 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008883 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008884 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008885
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008886 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
8887 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008888 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008889 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00008890 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
8891 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
8892 IsError = true;
8893 break;
8894 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008895
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00008896 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008897 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008898
8899 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
8900 }
8901
8902 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
8903 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
8904 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
8905 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008906 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
8907 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
8908 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008909 }
8910 }
8911
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008912 if (IsError) return true;
8913
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008914 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00008915 return true;
8916
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00008917 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008918}
8919
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008920/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008921/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008922/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008923ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008924Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008925 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
8926 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008927
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008928 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8929 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
8930 if (Result.isInvalid())
8931 return ExprError();
8932 Base = Result.take();
8933 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008934
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008935 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
8936
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008937 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
8938 //
8939 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
8940 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
8941 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
8942 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008943 DeclarationName OpName =
8944 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008945 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008946 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008947
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008948 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00008949 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
8950 << Base->getSourceRange()))
8951 return ExprError();
8952
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008953 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8954 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
8955 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00008956
8957 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008958 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008959 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
8960 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008961 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008962
8963 // Perform overload resolution.
8964 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008965 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008966 case OR_Success:
8967 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
8968 break;
8969
8970 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8971 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8972 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008973 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008974 else
8975 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008976 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008977 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008978 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008979
8980 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008981 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8982 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008983 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008984 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008985
8986 case OR_Deleted:
8987 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8988 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008989 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008990 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008991 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008992 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008993 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008994 }
8995
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008996 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008997 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008998 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008999
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009000 // Convert the object parameter.
9001 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009002 ExprResult BaseResult =
9003 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9004 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9005 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009006 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009007 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00009008
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009009 // Build the operator call.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009010 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9011 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9012 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009013
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009014 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9015 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9016 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009017 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009018 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009019 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009020
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009021 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009022 Method))
9023 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +00009024
9025 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009026}
9027
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009028/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
9029/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
9030/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
9031/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00009032/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00009033Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009034 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009035 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009036 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
9037 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009038 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009039 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009040
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009041 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009042 }
9043
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009044 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009045 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
9046 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009047 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009048 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00009049 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009050 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009051 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009052 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009053
9054 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009055 ICE->getCastKind(),
9056 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00009057 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009058 }
9059
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009060 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009061 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009062 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009063 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9064 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9065 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
9066 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009067 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009068 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
9069 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
9070 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009071 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9072 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009073 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009074 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009075
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009076 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
9077 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
9078 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
9079 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
9080
9081 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
9082 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
9083 // appropriate pointer to member type.
9084 QualType ClassType
9085 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
9086 QualType MemPtrType
9087 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
9088
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009089 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
9090 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9091 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009092 }
9093 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009094 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9095 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009096 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009097 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009098
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009099 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009100 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009101 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009102 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009103 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009104
9105 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009106 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9107 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009108 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009109 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9110 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009111 }
9112
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009113 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009114 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009115 Fn,
9116 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009117 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009118 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009119 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009120 }
9121
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009122 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009123 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009124 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9125 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9126 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9127 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9128 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009129
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009130 Expr *Base;
9131
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009132 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
9133 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009134 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
9135 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9136 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009137 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009138 Fn,
9139 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9140 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009141 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009142 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009143 } else {
9144 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
9145 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009146 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009147 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
9148 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
9149 /*isImplicit=*/true);
9150 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009151 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009152 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009153
9154 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009155 MemExpr->isArrow(),
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009156 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009157 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009158 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009159 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009160 TemplateArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009161 Fn->getType(),
9162 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()
9163 ? VK_LValue : VK_RValue,
9164 OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009165 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009166
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009167 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
9168 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009169}
9170
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009171ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009172 DeclAccessPair Found,
9173 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009174 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00009175}
9176
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009177} // end namespace clang